blob: 5c860b8021bfbc1eb836e8def956d4828b8e1286 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8441deb2021-08-01 18:19:51 +02007 2021/08/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200816 - a question mark ('!') preceeding any of the non-empty elements above, and
817 which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001113 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001114 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001115 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001116 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1117 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001119 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1120 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001124 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125
1126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128------------------------------------
1129
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001130ca-base <dir>
1131 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001132 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1133 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1134 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001135
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136chroot <jail dir>
1137 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1138 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1139 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1140 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1141 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001144cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001145 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001146 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1147 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1148 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1149 set. These sets have the format
1150
1151 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1152
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001153 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1154 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001155 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001156 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001157 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1158 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001159 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1160 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1161 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1162 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1163 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1164 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1165 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1166 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1167 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1168 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001169
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001170 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1171 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1172 on the machine's word size.
1173
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001174 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001175 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1176 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1177 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1178 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1179 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1180 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001181
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001182 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1183 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1184 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1185 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001187 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001188 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1189 # first 4 CPUs
1190
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001191 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1192 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 # word size.
1194
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001195 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1196 # and so on.
1197 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1200
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001201 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1202 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1203 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1204 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001205
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001206 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1207 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001209
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001210crt-base <dir>
1211 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001212 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1213 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001214
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001215daemon
1216 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1217 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001218 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1219 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001220
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001221default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001222 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001223 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1224 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1225 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1226 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1227 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1228 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1229 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1230 not start with a slash ('/'):
1231 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1232 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1233
1234 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1235 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1236 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1237 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1238 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1239 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1240 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1241 each of them.
1242
1243 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1244 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1245 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1246 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1247 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1248 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1249 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1250 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1251
1252 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1253 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001254 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001255 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1256 made easily relocatable.
1257
1258 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1259 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1260 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1261 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1262 consistent across all configuration files.
1263
1264 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1265 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1266 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1267 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1268 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1269 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1270 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1271 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1272
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1274 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276
1277deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001278 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001279 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1280
1281deviceatlas-separator <char>
1282 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1283 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1284
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001285deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001286 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1287 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1288 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001289
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001290expose-experimental-directives
1291 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1292 the config file will be rejected.
1293
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001294external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001295 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1296 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001297 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1298 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1299 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1300 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1301 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001304 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001305 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1306 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001307 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001308 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001310
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001311group <group name>
1312 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1313 See also "gid" and "user".
1314
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001315hard-stop-after <time>
1316 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1317
1318 Arguments :
1319 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1320 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1321 SIGUSR1 signal.
1322
1323 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1324 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1325 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1326
1327 Example:
1328 global
1329 hard-stop-after 30s
1330
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001331h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1332 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1333 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1334 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1335 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001336 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001337 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1338 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1339 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1340 specified in a proxy.
1341
1342 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1343 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1344 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1345 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1346 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1347 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1348 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1349
1350 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1351 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1352 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1353 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1354 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1355
1356 Example:
1357 global
1358 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1359
1360 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1361 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1362
1363h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1364 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1365 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1366 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1367 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1368 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1369 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1370 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1371 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1372
1373 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1374 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1375 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1376
1377 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1378 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1379
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001380insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001381 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001382 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1383 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1384 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1385 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1386 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1387 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1388 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001389 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001390 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1391 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1392 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1393 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1394 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1395 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1396 disable it.
1397
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001398insecure-setuid-wanted
1399 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1400 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1401 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1402 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001403 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001404 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1407 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001408 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001409 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1410 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1411 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1412 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1413
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001414issuers-chain-path <dir>
1415 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1416 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1417 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001418 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001419 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1420 "issuers-chain-path".
1421 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1422 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1423 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1424 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1425 will share the chain in memory.
1426
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001427h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1428 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1429 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1430 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1431 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1432 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1433 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1434 the keyword with "no'.
1435
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001436localpeer <name>
1437 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1438 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1439 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1440 the configuration parsing.
1441
1442 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1443 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1444
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001445log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001446 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001447 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001448 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001449 configured with "log global".
1450
1451 <address> can be one of:
1452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001453 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001454 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1455 port).
1456
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001457 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1458 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1459 port).
1460
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001461 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1463 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001464 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001465
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001466 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1467 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1468 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1469 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1470 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1471 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1472 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1473 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1474 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1475 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001477 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1478 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1479 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001480 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1481 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001482
1483 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1484 "fd@2", see above.
1485
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001486 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1487 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1488 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1489 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1490 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1491
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001492 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1493 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001494
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001495 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1496 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1497 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1498 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1499 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1500 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1501 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1502 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1503 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1504 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001505 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1506 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001507
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001508 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1509 one of the following :
1510
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001511 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1512 field is stripped. This is the default.
1513 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1514 rfc3164.
1515
1516 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1518
1519 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1520 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1521
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001522 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1523 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1524 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1525 designed to be used with a local log server.
1526
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001527 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1528 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1529 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1530 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1531 logger consumes.
1532
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001533 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1534 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1535 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1536 used with a local log server.
1537
1538 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1539 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1540 designed to be used with a local log server.
1541
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001542 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1543 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1544 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1545 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1546
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001547 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1548 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1549 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1550 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1551 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1552
1553 <sample_size>
1554 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1555 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1556 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1557 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1558 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1559
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001560 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001561
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001562 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1563 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1564 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1565
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001566 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1567 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1568 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1569 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001570
1571 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001572 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1573 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1574 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1575 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1576 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1577 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001579 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001580
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001581log-send-hostname [<string>]
1582 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1583 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1584 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1585 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1586 the logs.
1587
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001588log-tag <string>
1589 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1590 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1591 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001592 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001593
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001594lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001595 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1596 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1597 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1598 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1599 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1600 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001601 used multiple times.
1602
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001603lua-load-per-thread <file>
1604 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1605 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1606 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1607 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1608 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1609 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1610 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1611 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1612 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1613 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1614 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1615 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1616 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1617 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1618 times.
1619
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001620lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1621 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1622 variable.
1623 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1624 to "path".
1625
1626 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1627 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1628 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1629 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1630 will be checked earlier.
1631
1632 As an example by specifying the following path:
1633
1634 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1636
1637 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1638 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1640 paths if that does not exist either.
1641
1642 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1643 documentation.
1644
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001645master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001646 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1647 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1648 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001650 or daemon mode.
1651
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001652 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1653 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1654 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1655 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1656 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001657
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001658 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001659
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660mworker-max-reloads <number>
1661 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001662 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001663 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1664 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1665 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1666
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001667nbthread <number>
1668 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001669 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1670 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1671 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1672 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1673 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1674 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1675 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001676
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001677numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001678 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001679 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1680 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1681 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1682 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1683 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1684 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1685 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1686 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001688pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001689 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1690 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1691 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1692 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001693
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001694pp2-never-send-local
1695 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1696 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1697 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1698 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1699 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1700 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1701 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1702 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1703 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1704 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1705 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1706
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001707presetenv <name> <value>
1708 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1709 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1710 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1711 and "unsetenv".
1712
1713resetenv [<name> ...]
1714 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1715 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1716 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1717 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1718 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1719 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1720 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1721 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1722
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001723stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001724 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1725 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1726 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001727
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001728server-state-base <directory>
1729 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001730 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1731 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001732
1733server-state-file <file>
1734 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1735 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1736 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1737 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1738 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1739 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1740 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1741 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001742 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1743 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001744
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001745set-var <var-name> <expr>
1746 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1747 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1748 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1749 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1750 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1751 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1752 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1753 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1754 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1755
1756 Example:
1757 global
1758 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1759 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1760 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1761
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001762setenv <name> <value>
1763 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1764 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1765 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1766 and "unsetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001768set-dumpable
1769 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001770 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1771 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1772 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1773 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1774 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1775 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1776 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1777 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1778 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1779 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1780 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1781 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1782 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1783 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1784 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001785 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001786 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001787
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001788ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1790 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001791 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001792 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001793 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1794 information and recommendations see e.g.
1795 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1796 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1797 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1798 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001799
1800ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1802 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1803 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1804 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1805 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001806 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1807 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1808 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001809 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001810
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001811ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1813 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1814 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1815 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1816 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1817
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001818ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1820 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1821 keyword to see available options.
1822
1823 Example:
1824 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001825 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001826
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001827ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1829 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001830 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001831 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001832 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1833 information and recommendations see e.g.
1834 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1835 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1836 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1837 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1838 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001839
1840ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1842 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1843 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1844 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1845 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001846 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1847 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1848 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1849 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001850
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001851ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1853 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1854 keyword to see available options.
1855
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001856ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1858 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1859 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001861 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001862 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1863 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1864 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1865 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001866 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1867 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1868 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1869
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001870ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1871 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1872 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001873 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001874 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001875 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1876
1877 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001878
1879 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1880 and won't try to remove them.
1881
1882 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1883
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001884ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001885 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001886 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1887 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1888 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001889
1890 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1891 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1892 optimize the startup time.
1893
1894 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1895 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1896 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1897
1898 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001899 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001900
1901 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001902 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1903 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001904
1905 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1906 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1907 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1908 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1909 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001910 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001911
1912 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001913 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001914 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1915 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1916 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1917 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1918 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001919 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001920
1921 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1922
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001923 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924 a cert bundle.
1925
1926 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1927 separately in several "crt".
1928
1929 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1930 since files are loading separately.
1931
1932 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1933 required to commit them.
1934
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001935 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001937
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001938 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1939 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1940 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001941
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001942 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1943 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1944 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001945
1946 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001947 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1948 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001949
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001950 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1951 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1952
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001953 The default behavior is "all".
1954
1955 Example:
1956 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1957 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1958 ssl-load-extra-files none
1959
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001960 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1961 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001962
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001963ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1964 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1965 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1966 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1967
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001968ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001969 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001970 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1971 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1972 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1973 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1974 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1975 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001976 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001977
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001978stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1979 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1980 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1981 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001982 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001983 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001984
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001985 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1986 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1987 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001988
1989stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1990 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1991 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001992 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001993
1994stats maxconn <connections>
1995 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1996 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1997
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001998uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001999 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2001 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2002 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2003
2004ulimit-n <number>
2005 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2006 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2007 option.
2008
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002009unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2010 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2011
2012 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2013 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2014 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2015 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2016 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002017 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002018 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2019 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2020 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2021 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2022
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002023unsetenv [<name> ...]
2024 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2025 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2026 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2027 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2028 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2029 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2030 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032user <user name>
2033 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2034 See also "uid" and "group".
2035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002036node <name>
2037 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2038
2039 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2040 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2041 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2042 traffic.
2043
2044description <text>
2045 Add a text that describes the instance.
2046
2047 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2048 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2049 "<" and ">" characters.
2050
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205151degrees-data-file <file path>
2052 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002053 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002054
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002055 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002056 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2057
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000205851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002059 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2060 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2061 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2062
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002063 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2065
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002067 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2068 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2069
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002070 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002071 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2072
207351degrees-cache-size <number>
2074 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2075 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2076 By default, this cache is disabled.
2077
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002078 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2080
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002081wurfl-data-file <file path>
2082 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2083 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2084
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002085 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002086 with USE_WURFL=1.
2087
2088wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2089 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2090 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2091 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2092
2093 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2094
2095 Valid WURFL properties are:
2096 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2097
2098 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2099 device.
2100
2101 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2102 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2103
2104 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2105 particular web request.
2106
2107 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2108 used Libwurfl API version.
2109
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002110 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2111 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2112
2113 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2114 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2115
2116 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002118 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002119 with USE_WURFL=1.
2120
2121wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2122 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2123 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2124
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002125 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002126 with USE_WURFL=1.
2127
2128wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2129 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2130 thus before the chroot.
2131
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002132 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002133 with USE_WURFL=1.
2134
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002135wurfl-cache-size <size>
2136 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2137 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002139 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002140
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002141 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142 with USE_WURFL=1.
2143
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002144strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002146 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2147 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002148 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002149 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002152-----------------------
2153
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002154busy-polling
2155 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2156 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2157 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2158 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2159 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2160 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2161 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2162 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2163 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2164 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2165 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2166 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2167 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2168 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2169 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2170 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2171 "poll" pollers.
2172
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002173 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2174 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2175 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2176
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002177max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002178 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002179 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2180 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2181 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2182 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2183 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2184 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2185 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002187maxconn <number>
2188 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2189 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2190 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002191 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2192 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2193 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2194 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002195 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2196 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2197 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2198 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2199 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2200 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002201
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002202maxconnrate <number>
2203 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2204 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2205 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2206 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2207 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2208 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2209 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2210 fairness.
2211
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002212maxcomprate <number>
2213 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002214 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002215 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2216 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2217 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002218 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002219 default value.
2220
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002221maxcompcpuusage <number>
2222 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2223 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2224 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002225 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2226 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2227 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2228 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002229
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002230maxpipes <number>
2231 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2232 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2233 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2234 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2235 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2236 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2237
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002238maxsessrate <number>
2239 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2240 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2241 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2242 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2243 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2244 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2245 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2246 fairness.
2247
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002248maxsslconn <number>
2249 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2250 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2251 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2252 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2253 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2254 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2255 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002256 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2257 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2258 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2259 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002260 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002261 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2262 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002263
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002264maxsslrate <number>
2265 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2266 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2267 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2268 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2269 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2270 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2271 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2272 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2273 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2274 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2275
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002276maxzlibmem <number>
2277 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2278 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2279 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002280 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2281 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2282 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2283
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002284noepoll
2285 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2286 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002287 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002288
2289nokqueue
2290 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2291 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2292 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2293
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002294noevports
2295 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2296 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2297 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2298 also "nopoll".
2299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300nopoll
2301 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2302 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002303 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002304 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2305 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002306
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002307nosplice
2308 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002309 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002310 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002311 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002312 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2313 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2314 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2315 "option splice-response".
2316
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002317nogetaddrinfo
2318 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2319 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2320
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002321noreuseport
2322 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2323 command line argument "-dR".
2324
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002325profiling.memory { on | off }
2326 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2327 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2328 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2329 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2330 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2331 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2332 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2333 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2334 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2335
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002336profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2337 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2338 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2339 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2340 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002341 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002342 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2343 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2344 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2345 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2346
2347 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2348 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2349 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2350 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2351 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002352 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2353 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2354 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2355 CLI.
2356
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002357spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002358 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2359 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2360 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2361 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2362 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2363 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002365ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002366 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002367 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002368 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002369 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002370 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2371 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2372 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002373 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2374 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002375 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2376 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2377 openssl configuration file uses:
2378 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2379
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002380ssl-mode-async
2381 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002382 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002383 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2384 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002385 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002386 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002387 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002388
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002389tune.buffers.limit <number>
2390 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2391 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2392 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2393 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2394 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002395 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002396 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2397 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2398 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2399 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2400 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2401 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2402 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2403 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002404 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002405
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002406tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2407 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2408 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2409 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002410 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002411
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002412tune.bufsize <number>
2413 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2414 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2415 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2416 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2417 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2418 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2419 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002420 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2421 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002423 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002424 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002425 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2426 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002427
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002428tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2429 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2430 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2431 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2432 this value. The default value is 1.
2433
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002434tune.fail-alloc
2435 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2436 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2437 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2438 gracefully.
2439
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002440tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2441 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2442 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2443 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2444 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2445 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2446
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002447tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2448 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2449 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2450 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2451 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2452 change it.
2453
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002454tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2455 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002456 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002457 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002458 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2459 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2460 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2461 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2462 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2463
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002464tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2465 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2466 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2467 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2468 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2469 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002470 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002471 recommended not to change this value.
2472
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002473tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002474 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002475 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002476 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002477 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2478 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2479 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2480 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2481
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002482tune.http.cookielen <number>
2483 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2484 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2485 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2486 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2487 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2488 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2489 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2490 to change this value.
2491
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002492tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002493 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2494 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002495 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002496 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002497 configuration directives too.
2498 The default value is 1024.
2499
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002500tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2501 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2502 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2503 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2504 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2505 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2506 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002507 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2508 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2509 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002510
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002511tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2512 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2513 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2514 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2515 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2516 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2517 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002518 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2519 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2520 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2521 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2522 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002523
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002524tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002525 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002526 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2527 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2528 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2529 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002530 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002531 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002532 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002533 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2534
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002535tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2536 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2537 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2538 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2539 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2540 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2541 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2542 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2543 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2544 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2545
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002546tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2547 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002548 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002549 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2550 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002551 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002552 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2553 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2554
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002555tune.lua.maxmem
2556 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2557 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2558 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2559 memory.
2560
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002561tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2562 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002563 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2564 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002565 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002566
2567tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2568 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2569 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2570 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2571 check servers.
2572
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002573tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2574 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2575 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2576 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002577 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002578
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002579tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002580 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2581 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002582 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2583 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2584 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2585 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2586 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2587 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2588 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2589 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2590 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002591
2592tune.maxpollevents <number>
2593 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2594 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2595 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2596 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2597 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2598
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002599tune.maxrewrite <number>
2600 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2601 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2602 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2603 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2604 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2605 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2606 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2607 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2608 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2609 bufsize.
2610
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002611tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2612 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2613 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2614 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2615 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2616 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2617 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2618 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2619 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2620 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002621 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2622 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002623 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2624 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2625 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2626 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2627 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2628 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2629 setting this parameter to 0.
2630
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002631tune.pipesize <number>
2632 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2633 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2634 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2635 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2636 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2637 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2638
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002639tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2640 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002641 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002642 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2643 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2644 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2645 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002646 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002647
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002648tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2649 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002650 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002651 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2652 default is 20.
2653
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002654tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2655tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2656 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2657 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2658 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002659 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002660 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002661 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2662 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2663
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002664tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002666 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2667 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2668 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2669 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2670
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002671tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002672 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002673 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2674 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2675 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2676 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2677 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2678 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2679 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002680
2681tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2682 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002683 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002684 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2685 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2686 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2687 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2688 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2689 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2690 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002691
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002692tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2693tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2694 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2695 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2696 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002697 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002698 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002699 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2700 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2701 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2702 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002703 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002704
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002705tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002706 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002707 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2708 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2709 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2710 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2711 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2712 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2713 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2714 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2715 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002716 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2717 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002718
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002719tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002720 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002721 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2722 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2723 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2724 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2725 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2726
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002727tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2728 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2729 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2730 performances. This is disabled by default.
2731
2732 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2733 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2734
2735 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2736
2737 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2738
2739 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2740
2741 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2742 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2743 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2744
2745 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2746 converted.
2747
2748 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2749 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2750 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2751 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2752 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2753 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2754 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002755 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2756 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002757
2758 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2759
2760 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2761 only need this line:
2762
2763 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2764
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002765tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2766 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002767 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002768 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2769 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2770 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2771 being used for too long.
2772
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002773tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2774 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2775 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2776 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2777 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2778 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2779 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2780 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2781 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2782 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2783 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002784 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002785 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002786
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002787tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2788 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2789 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2790 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2791 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002792 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002793 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2794 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002795 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2796 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002797
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002798tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2799 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2800 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2801 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2802 1000 entries.
2803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002804tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2805 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2806 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2807 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2808
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002809tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002810tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002811tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2812tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2813tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002814 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2815 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2816 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2817 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2818 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2819 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2820 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2821 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002823 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2824 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2825 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2826 all available space is consumed.
2827 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2828 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2829 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002830
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002831tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2832 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002833 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002834 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002835 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002836 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2837
2838tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2839 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2840 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002841 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2842 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028443.3. Debugging
2845--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002847quiet
2848 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2849 line argument "-q".
2850
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002851zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002852 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002853 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2854 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2855 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2856 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2857 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2858
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028603.4. Userlists
2861--------------
2862It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2863http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2864it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2865
2866userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002867 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002868 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2869
2870group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002871 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002872 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2873 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2874
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002875user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2876 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002877 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2878 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002879 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2880 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2881 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2882 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002883
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002884 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2885 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2886 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2887 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2888 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2889 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2890 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002891 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002892 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002893
2894 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002895 userlist L1
2896 group G1 users tiger,scott
2897 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002898
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002899 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2900 user scott insecure-password elgato
2901 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002902
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002903 userlist L2
2904 group G1
2905 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002906
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002907 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2908 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2909 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002910
2911 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002912
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002913
29143.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002915----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002916It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002917several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002918instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2919values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2920automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2921In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2922using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2923tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2924reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2925Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2926that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2927each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002928
2929peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002930 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002931 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2932
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002933bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2934 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2935 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2936
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002937disabled
2938 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2939 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2940 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2941
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002942default-bind [param*]
2943 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2944
2945default-server [param*]
2946 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2947
2948 Arguments:
2949 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2950 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2951 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2952 details.
2953
2954
2955 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2956
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002957enable
2958 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2959
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002960log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002961 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2962 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2963 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2964 more details.
2965
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002966peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002967 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2968 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002969 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002970 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002971 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2972 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2973 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002974
2975 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2976 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2977
2978 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002979 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2980 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2981 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002982
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002983 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2984 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002985
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002986 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2987 "server" keyword explanation below).
2988
2989server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002990 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002991 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2992 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2993 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2994 of this "peers" section).
2995 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2996
2997
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002998 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002999 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003000 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003001 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3002 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3003 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003004
3005 backend mybackend
3006 mode tcp
3007 balance roundrobin
3008 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3009 stick on src
3010
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003011 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3012 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003013
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003014 Example:
3015 peers mypeers
3016 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3017 default-server ssl verify none
3018 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3019 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003021
3022table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3023 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3024
3025 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3026 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003027 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003028 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3029 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3030 "stick-table" keyword).
3031
3032 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3033 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3034 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3035 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3036 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3037 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3038 of the stick-table name as follows:
3039
3040 peers mypeers
3041 peer A ...
3042 peer B ...
3043 table t1 ...
3044
3045 frontend fe1
3046 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3047
3048 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3049 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3050
3051 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3052 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3053 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3054 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3055 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3056 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3057 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3058
3059 peers mypeers
3060 peer A ...
3061 peer B ...
3062 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3063
3064 backend t1
3065 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3066
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003067 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003068 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3069 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3070
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030713.6. Mailers
3072------------
3073It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3074If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3075in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3076
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003077mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003078 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3079 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3080
3081mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3082 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3083
3084 Example:
3085 mailers mymailers
3086 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3087 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3088
3089 backend mybackend
3090 mode tcp
3091 balance roundrobin
3092
3093 email-alert mailers mymailers
3094 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3095 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3096
3097 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3098 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3099
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003100timeout mail <time>
3101 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3102 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3103 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3104 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3105
3106 Example:
3107 mailers mymailers
3108 timeout mail 20s
3109 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003110
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031113.7. Programs
3112-------------
3113In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3114master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3115managed the same way as the workers.
3116
3117During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3118sequence as a worker:
3119
3120 - the master is re-executed
3121 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3122 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3123 instance of the program
3124
3125During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3126
3127program <name>
3128 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3129 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3130 the management guide).
3131
3132command <command> [arguments*]
3133 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3134 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3135 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3136 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3137
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003138user <user name>
3139 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3140 See also "group".
3141
3142group <group name>
3143 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3144 See also "user".
3145
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003146option start-on-reload
3147no option start-on-reload
3148 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3149 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3150 program section.
3151
3152
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031533.8. HTTP-errors
3154----------------
3155
3156It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3157imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3158several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3159
3160http-errors <name>
3161 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3162 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3163
3164errorfile <code> <file>
3165 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3166
3167 Arguments :
3168 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003169 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003170 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003171
3172 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3173 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3174 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3175 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3176 before any chroot is performed.
3177
3178 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3179
3180 Example:
3181 http-errors website-1
3182 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3183 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3184 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3185
3186 http-errors website-2
3187 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3188 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3189 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3190
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031913.9. Rings
3192----------
3193
3194It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3195servers or traces.
3196
3197ring <ringname>
3198 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3199
3200description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003201 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003202 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3203
3204format <format>
3205 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3206
3207 Arguments:
3208 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3209 one of the following :
3210
3211 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3212 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3213 designed to be used with a local log server.
3214
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003215 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3216 field is stripped. This is the default.
3217 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3218 rfc3164.
3219
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003220 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3221 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3222 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3223 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3224 is the default.
3225
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003226 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003227 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3228
3229 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3230 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3231
3232 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3233 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3234 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3235 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3236 logger consumes.
3237
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003238 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3239 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3240 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3241 with a local log server.
3242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003243 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3244 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3245 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3246 used with a local log server.
3247
3248maxlen <length>
3249 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3250 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3251 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3252
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003253server <name> <address> [param*]
3254 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3255 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3256 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3257 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3258 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3259 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3260 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3261 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3262 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003263 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3264 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003265
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003266size <size>
3267 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3268 set to BUFSIZE.
3269
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003270timeout connect <timeout>
3271 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3272
3273 Arguments :
3274 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3275 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3276 as explained at the top of this document.
3277
3278timeout server <timeout>
3279 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3280
3281 Arguments :
3282 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3283 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3284 as explained at the top of this document.
3285
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003286 Example:
3287 global
3288 log ring@myring local7
3289
3290 ring myring
3291 description "My local buffer"
3292 format rfc3164
3293 maxlen 1200
3294 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003295 timeout connect 5s
3296 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003297 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032993.10. Log forwarding
3300-------------------
3301
3302It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003303HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003304
3305log-forward <name>
3306 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3307
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003308backlog <conns>
3309 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3310 on connections accept.
3311
3312bind <addr> [param*]
3313 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003314 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3315 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3316 syslog protocol over TCP.
3317 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003318 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3319
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003320dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003321 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3322 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3323 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3324 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003325 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003326
3327log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003328log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003329 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3330 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3331 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003332 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003333 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3334 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3335 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003336 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003337
3338 Example:
3339 global
3340 log stderr format iso local7
3341
3342 ring myring
3343 description "My local buffer"
3344 format rfc5424
3345 maxlen 1200
3346 size 32764
3347 timeout connect 5s
3348 timeout server 10s
3349 # syslog tcp server
3350 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3351
3352 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003353 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3354 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003355 # all messages on stderr
3356 log global
3357 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3358 log ring@myring local0
3359 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3360 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3361 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3362 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3363 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003364
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003365maxconn <conns>
3366 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3367 10 is the default.
3368
3369timeout client <timeout>
3370 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033724. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003373----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003374
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003375Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003376 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3377 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3378 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3379 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380
3381A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3382connections.
3383
3384A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3385to forward incoming connections.
3386
3387A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3388parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3389
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003390A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3391ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3392sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3393the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3394explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3395from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3396"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3397for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3398to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3399optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3400are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3401any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3402names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3403that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3404duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3405names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3406
3407Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3408settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3409of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3410profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3411timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3412
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003413All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3414'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3415case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3416
3417Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3418logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3419proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3420However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3421name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3422
3423Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3424and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003425bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3427modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3428arbitrary criteria.
3429
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003430In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3431a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003432the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003433
3434 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3435 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3436 between responses and new requests.
3437
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003438 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3439 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3440 client-facing connection remains open.
3441
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003442 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3443 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003444
3445The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3446frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3447following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003448weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003449
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003450 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003451
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003452 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3453 ----+-----+-----+----
3454 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3455 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003456 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3457 ----+-----+-----+----
3458 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003459
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003460It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003461only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3462within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003463as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003464content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003465and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3466possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003468There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003469first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003471second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003472protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3473is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3474new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003475to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003476process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3477already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3478HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3479evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3480one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3481
3482There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3483performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3484tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3485preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3486analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3487HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3488header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3489mitigate this drawback.
3490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003491There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003492method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3493set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3494in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3495is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3496to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3497above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3498to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3499"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3500frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3501frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3502as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3503upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3504on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3505the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3506upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3507frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3508remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035104.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3511--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003513The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3514limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3515they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3516limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003517marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003518option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003519and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3520with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3521specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003523
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003524 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3525------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3526acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003527backlog X X X -
3528balance X - X X
3529bind - X X -
3530bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531capture cookie - X X -
3532capture request header - X X -
3533capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003534clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3535clitcpka-idle X X X -
3536clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003537compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003539declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540default-server X - X X
3541default_backend X X X -
3542description - X X X
3543disabled X X X X
3544dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003545email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003546email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003547email-alert mailers X X X X
3548email-alert myhostname X X X X
3549email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550enabled X X X X
3551errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003552errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553errorloc X X X X
3554errorloc302 X X X X
3555-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3556errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003557force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003558filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003559fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003561http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003562http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003563http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003564http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003565http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003566http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003567http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003568http-check set-var X - X X
3569http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003570http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003571http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003572http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003573http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003574http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003575id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003576ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003577load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003578log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003579log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003580log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003581log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003582max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583maxconn X X X -
3584mode X X X X
3585monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003586monitor-uri X X X -
3587option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3588option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3589option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3590option allbackups (*) X - X X
3591option checkcache (*) X - X X
3592option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3593option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003594option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003595option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3596option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3598option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3600option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003601option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003602option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003603option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003604option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003605option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3607option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3608option httpchk X - X X
3609option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003610option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003611option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003612option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003613option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003614option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003615option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3616option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3617option logasap (*) X X X -
3618option mysql-check X - X X
3619option nolinger (*) X X X X
3620option originalto X X X X
3621option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003622option pgsql-check X - X X
3623option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003625option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003626option smtpchk X - X X
3627option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3628option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3629option splice-request (*) X X X X
3630option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003631option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3633option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3634-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003635option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3637option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3638option tcpka X X X X
3639option tcplog X X X X
3640option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003641external-check command X - X X
3642external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3644rate-limit sessions X X X -
3645redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003647retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003648retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003650server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003651server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003652source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003653srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3654srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3655srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003656stats admin - X X X
3657stats auth X X X X
3658stats enable X X X X
3659stats hide-version X X X X
3660stats http-request - X X X
3661stats realm X X X X
3662stats refresh X X X X
3663stats scope X X X X
3664stats show-desc X X X X
3665stats show-legends X X X X
3666stats show-node X X X X
3667stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003668-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3669stick match - - X X
3670stick on - - X X
3671stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003672stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003673stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003674tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003675tcp-check connect X - X X
3676tcp-check expect X - X X
3677tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003678tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003679tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003680tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003681tcp-check set-var X - X X
3682tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003683tcp-request connection - X X -
3684tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003685tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003686tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003687tcp-response content - - X X
3688tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003689timeout check X - X X
3690timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003691timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3694timeout http-request X X X X
3695timeout queue X - X X
3696timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003697timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003699timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003701unique-id-format X X X -
3702unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003703use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003704use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003705use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3707 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037104.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3711---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003712
3713This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3714
3715
3716acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3717 Declare or complete an access list.
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 no | yes | yes | yes
3720 Example:
3721 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3722 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3723 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003725 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003726
3727
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003728backlog <conns>
3729 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | no
3732 Arguments :
3733 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3734 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003735 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003736
3737 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3738 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3739 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3740 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3741 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3742 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3743 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3744 backlog parameter.
3745
3746 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3747 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3748 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3749
3750 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3751
3752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003754balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3757 yes | no | yes | yes
3758 Arguments :
3759 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3760 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3761 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3762 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3763
3764 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3765 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3766 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3767 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003768 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003769 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003770 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3771 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3772 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3773 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3774 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3775 it, so that you don't worry.
3776
3777 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3778 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3779 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3780 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3781 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3782 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3783 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3784 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003785
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003786 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3787 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3788 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3789 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3790 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3791 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3792 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003793 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3794 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3795 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003796
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003797 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003798 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003799 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3800 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003801 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003802 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3803 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3804 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3805 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3806 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003807 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3808 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3809 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3810 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3811 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3812 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003814 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3815 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3816 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3817 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3818 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3819 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3820 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3821 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003822 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003824 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3825 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3826 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003828 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3829 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3830 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3831 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3832 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3833 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3834 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3835 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3836 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3837 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3838 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3839 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003841 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003842 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3843 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3844 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3845 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3846 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3847 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3848 URIs start with a leading "/".
3849
3850 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3851 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3852 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3853 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3854
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003855 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3856 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3857 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3858 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003861 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3862
3863 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003864 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3865 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003866 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3867 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3868 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3869 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003870 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003871 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3872 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003873
3874 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3875 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3876 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3877 server will receive the request.
3878
3879 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3880 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3881 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3882 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3883 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003884 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3885 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3886 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003888 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3889 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3890 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3891 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3892 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003894 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003895 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3896 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3897 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3898
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003899 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3900 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3901 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3902
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003903 random
3904 random(<draws>)
3905 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003906 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3907 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3908 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3909 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003910 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3911 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3912 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3913 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3914 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3915 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3916 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3917 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3918 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3919 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3920 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3921 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3922 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3923 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3924 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3925 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3926 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3927 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3928 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3929 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003930
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003931 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003932 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003933 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3934 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3935 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3936 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3937 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3938 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003939 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003940 used instead.
3941
3942 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3943 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3944 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3945 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3946
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003947 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3948 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3949 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3950
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003951 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003953 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003954 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3955 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003956
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003957 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3958 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3959 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003961 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003962 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003963 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3964 NTLM relies on.
3965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 Examples :
3967 balance roundrobin
3968 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003969 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003970 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3971 balance hdr(host)
3972 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003973
3974 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3975 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003977 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003978 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3979 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3980 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003981 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003982
3983 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3984 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3985 defaults to 16 kB.
3986
3987 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3988 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3989
3990 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3991 Round Robin.
3992
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003993 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003994 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3995 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3996 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3997
3998 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3999
4000 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004001 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004002 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4003 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4004 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004006 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004007
4008
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004009bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4010bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 no | yes | yes | no
4014 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004015 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4016 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4017 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4018 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004019 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004020 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4021 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4022 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4023 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4024 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4025 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004026 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004027 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4028 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004029 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004030 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4031 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004032 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004033 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4034 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004035 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004036 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004037 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4038 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4039 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004040 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4041 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4042 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4043 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004044 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4045 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4046 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004047
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004048 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4049 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004050 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4051 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4052 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004053 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4054 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4055 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4056 the range.
4057
4058 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4059 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4060 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4061 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4062 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4063 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4064 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004065 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004066 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004068 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004069 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004070 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4071 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4072 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4073 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4074 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4075 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004077 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4078 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4079 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4080 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004082 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4083 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4084 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4085 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4086 in a frontend.
4087
4088 Example :
4089 listen http_proxy
4090 bind :80,:443
4091 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004092 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004094 listen http_https_proxy
4095 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004096 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004097
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004098 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4099 bind ipv6@:80
4100 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4101 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4102
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004103 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004104 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004105
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004106 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4107 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4108 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4109 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4110 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4111
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004112 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004113 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
4115
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004116bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004119
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004120 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4121 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4122 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4123 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4124 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4125 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004126
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004127 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004128
4129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130capture cookie <name> len <length>
4131 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4133 no | yes | yes | no
4134 Arguments :
4135 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4136 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4137 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4138 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004139 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004140
4141 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4142 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4143 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4144 right if it exceeds <length>.
4145
4146 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4147 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4148 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4149 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4150
4151 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4152 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4153 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4154
4155 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4156 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4157 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004158 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4159 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4160 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004161
4162 Example:
4163 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4164
4165 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004166 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167
4168
4169capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004170 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 no | yes | yes | no
4173 Arguments :
4174 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004175 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004176 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4177 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4178 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4179
4180 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4181 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4182 it exceeds <length>.
4183
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004184 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004185 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4186 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004187 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4188 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4189 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4190 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004191 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004192 environments to find where the request came from.
4193
4194 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4195 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4196 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4197 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004198
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004199 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4200 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4201 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4202 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4203 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204
4205 Example:
4206 capture request header Host len 15
4207 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004208 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004210 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211 about logging.
4212
4213
4214capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004215 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 no | yes | yes | no
4218 Arguments :
4219 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004220 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4222 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4223 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4224
4225 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4226 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4227 it exceeds <length>.
4228
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004229 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004230 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4231 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4232 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004233 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4234 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4235 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4236 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004238 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4239 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4240 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4241 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4242 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004243
4244 Example:
4245 capture response header Content-length len 9
4246 capture response header Location len 15
4247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004248 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004249 about logging.
4250
4251
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004252clitcpka-cnt <count>
4253 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4254 the connection on the client side.
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | yes | yes | no
4257 Arguments :
4258 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4259
4260 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4261 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004262 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4263 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004264
4265 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4266
4267
4268clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4269 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4270 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4271 client side.
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments :
4275 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4276 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4277 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4278 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4279
4280 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4281 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004282 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4283 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004284
4285 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4286
4287
4288clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4289 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | yes | yes | no
4292 Arguments :
4293 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4294 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4295 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4296 document.
4297
4298 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4299 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004300 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4301 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004302
4303 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4304
4305
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004306compression algo <algorithm> ...
4307compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004308compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004309 Enable HTTP compression.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | yes | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004313 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4314 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004315 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004316
4317 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004318 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4319 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4320 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004321
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004322 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004323 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004324
4325 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4326 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4327 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4328 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4329 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004330 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004331
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004332 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4333 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4334 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4335 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4336 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4337 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4338 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004339 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004340
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004341 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004342 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004343 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004344 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004345 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004346 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004347 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004349 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004350 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4351 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004352 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4353 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004354 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004355 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004356 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4357 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004358 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004359 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4360 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004361
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004362 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004363 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4364 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004365 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004366 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004367 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4368 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4369 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4370 "multipart"
4371 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4372 header
4373 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4374 and later
4375 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4376 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004377 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004378
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004379 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004380
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004381 Examples :
4382 compression algo gzip
4383 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004384
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004385
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004386cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004387 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4388 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004389 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | no | yes | yes
4393 Arguments :
4394 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4395 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4396 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4397 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4398 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4399 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004400 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004401 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4402 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4403
4404 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004405 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004406 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4407 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4408 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4409 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004410 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4411 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004412 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004413 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4414 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004415
4416 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004417 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004418
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004419 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004420 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004421 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004422 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004423 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4424 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4425 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4426 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4427 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4428 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4429 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004430
4431 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4432 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4433 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4434 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4435 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4436 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4437 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4438 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4439 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004440 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004441 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4442 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4443 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004444
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004445 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4446 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4447 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004448 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4449 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4450 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4451 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004452 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4453 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4454 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004455
4456 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4457 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4458 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4459 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4460 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4461 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4462 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4463 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4464 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4465
4466 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4467 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4468 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4469 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4470 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4471 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4472 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4473 persistence cookie in the cache.
4474 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4475
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004476 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4477 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004478 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004479 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4480 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004481 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004482 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4483 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4484 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4485 they logout.
4486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004487 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004488 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4489 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4490 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4491
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004492 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004493 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4494 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4495 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4496 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4497 this attribute.
4498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004499 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004500 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004501 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4502 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4503 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4504 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4505 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4506 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004507
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004508 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4509 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4510 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4511 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4512 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4513 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4514 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4515 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004516 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004517 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4518 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4519 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4520 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4521 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4522 the site.
4523
4524 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4525 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4526 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4527 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4528 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4529 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4530 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4531 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4532 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4533 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4534 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4535 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4536 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004537 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004538 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4539 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4540
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004541 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4542 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4543 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4544 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4545 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4546 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4547
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004548 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004549 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4550 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4551 repeated.
4552
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004553 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4554 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4555 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4556 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004558 Examples :
4559 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4560 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4561 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004562 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004563
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004564 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004565
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004566
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004567declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4568 Declares a capture slot.
4569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 no | yes | yes | no
4571 Arguments:
4572 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4573
4574 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4575 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4576 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4577 for use in the response.
4578
4579 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004580 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004581 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4582
4583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004584default-server [param*]
4585 Change default options for a server in a backend
4586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4587 yes | no | yes | yes
4588 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004589 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4590 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4591 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4592 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004593
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004594 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004595 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4596
4597 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004598
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004600default_backend <backend>
4601 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 yes | yes | yes | no
4604 Arguments :
4605 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4606
4607 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4608 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4609 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4610 will catch all undetermined requests.
4611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004612 Example :
4613
4614 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4615 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4616 default_backend dynamic
4617
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004618 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004621description <string>
4622 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 no | yes | yes | yes
4625 Arguments : string
4626
4627 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4628 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4629 it describes.
4630 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4631
4632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004633disabled
4634 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4636 yes | yes | yes | yes
4637 Arguments : none
4638
4639 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4640 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4641 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4642 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4643 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4644 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4645 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4646
4647 See also : "enabled"
4648
4649
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004650dispatch <address>:<port>
4651 Set a default server address
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004654 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004655
4656 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4657 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4658 during start-up.
4659
4660 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4661 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4662 possible with normal servers.
4663
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004664 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004665 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4666 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4667 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4668 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4669
4670 See also : "server"
4671
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004672
4673dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4674 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 yes | no | yes | yes
4677 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4678
4679 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004680 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004681 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4682 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004683 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004684 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004686enabled
4687 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 yes | yes | yes | yes
4690 Arguments : none
4691
4692 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4693 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4694
4695 See also : "disabled"
4696
4697
4698errorfile <code> <file>
4699 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments :
4703 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004704 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004705 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706
4707 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004708 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004710 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4711 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712
4713 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4714 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4715 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4716
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004717 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4718
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004719 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4720 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4721 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4722 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4723 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4724 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4725 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4726 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4727 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004729 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4730 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4731 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004732 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4734
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004735 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004737 Example :
4738 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004739 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004740 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4741 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4742
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004743
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004744errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4745 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4746 section.
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | yes | yes | yes
4749 Arguments :
4750 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4751
4752 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004753 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004754 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4755 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004756
4757 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4758 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4759 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4760 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4761 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004762 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004763 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4764
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004765 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4766 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004767
4768 Example :
4769 errorfiles generic
4770 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4771
4772
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004773errorloc <code> <url>
4774errorloc302 <code> <url>
4775 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4777 yes | yes | yes | yes
4778 Arguments :
4779 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004780 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004781 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004782
4783 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4784 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4785 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4786 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004787 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004788
4789 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4790 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4791 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4792
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004793 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4796 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4797 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4798 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004799 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004800 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4801 request.
4802
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004803 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004804
4805
4806errorloc303 <code> <url>
4807 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | yes | yes | yes
4810 Arguments :
4811 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004812 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004813 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004814
4815 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4816 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4817 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4818 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004819 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004820
4821 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4822 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4823 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4824
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004825 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4826
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004827 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4828 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4829 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4830 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004831 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004833 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834
4835
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004836email-alert from <emailaddr>
4837 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004838 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4840 yes | yes | yes | yes
4841
4842 Arguments :
4843
4844 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4845
4846 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4847 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4848
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004849 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004850 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4851 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004852
4853
4854email-alert level <level>
4855 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4856 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4858 yes | yes | yes | yes
4859
4860 Arguments :
4861
4862 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4863 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4864 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4865
4866 By default level is alert
4867
4868 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4869 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4870 for the proxy.
4871
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004872 Alerts are sent when :
4873
4874 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4875 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4876 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4877 is notice or lower
4878 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4879 and a health check status update occurs
4880
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004881 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4882 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004883 section 3.6 about mailers.
4884
4885
4886email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4887 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4889 yes | yes | yes | yes
4890
4891 Arguments :
4892
4893 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4894
4895 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4896 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4897
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004898 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4899 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004900
4901
4902email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4903 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4904 mailers.
4905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | yes | yes | yes
4907
4908 Arguments :
4909
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004910 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004911
4912 By default the systems hostname is used.
4913
4914 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4915 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4916 for the proxy.
4917
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004918 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4919 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004920
4921
4922email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004923 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004924 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4926 yes | yes | yes | yes
4927
4928 Arguments :
4929
4930 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4931
4932 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4933 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4934
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004935 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004936 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4937
4938
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004939force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4940 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004942 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004943
4944 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4945 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4946 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4947 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4948 marked down for maintenance operations.
4949
4950 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4951 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4952 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4953 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4954 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4955 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4956 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4957 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4958 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4959
4960 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4961 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4962 is used.
4963
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004964 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004965 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004966
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004967
4968filter <name> [param*]
4969 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 no | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments :
4973 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4974 referenced in section 9.
4975
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004976 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004977 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004978 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4979 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004980
4981 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4982 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4983
4984 Example:
4985 listen
4986 bind *:80
4987
4988 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4989 filter compression
4990 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4991
4992 compression algo gzip
4993 compression offload
4994
4995 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4996
4997 See also : section 9.
4998
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004999
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005000fullconn <conns>
5001 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5003 yes | no | yes | yes
5004 Arguments :
5005 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5006 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5007
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005008 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005009 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005010 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005011 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5012 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5013 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5014 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5015 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005016 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005017
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005018 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005019 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005020 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5021 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5022 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005023
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005024 Example :
5025 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5026 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5027 # connections.
5028 backend dynamic
5029 fullconn 10000
5030 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5031 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5032
5033 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5034
5035
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005036hash-balance-factor <factor>
5037 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | no | yes
5040 Arguments :
5041 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5042 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005043 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005044
5045 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5046 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5047 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5048 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5049 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5050 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5051 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5052
5053 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5054 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5055 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5056 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5057 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5058
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005059 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5060 consistent hashing mechanism.
5061
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005062 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5063
5064
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005065hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005066 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5068 yes | no | yes | yes
5069 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005070 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5071 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005072
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005073 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5074 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5075 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5076 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5077 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5078 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5079 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5080 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5081 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5082 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005083
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005084 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5085 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5086 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5087 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5088 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5089 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5090 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5091 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5092 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5093 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5094 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5095 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5096 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005097 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5098 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005099
5100 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5101
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005102 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005103 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5104 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5105 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005106 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5107 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5108 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005109
5110 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5111 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005112 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5113 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5114 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5115 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005117 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005118 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5119 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5120 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5121 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5122 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5123 parameter.
5124
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005125 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5126 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5127 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5128 used on strings.
5129
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005130 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5131
5132 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5133 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5134 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5135 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5136 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5137 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5138 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5139 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5140 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5141 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5142 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5143 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005144
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005145 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5146 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5147 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005148
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005149 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005150
5151
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005152http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5153 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5154 ones).
5155
5156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 no | yes | yes | yes
5158
5159 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5160 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5161 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5162 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5163 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5164 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5165
5166 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5167 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5168 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5169
5170 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5171 below.
5172
5173 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5174 instance.
5175
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005176 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5177 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5178 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5179
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005180 Example:
5181 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5182 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5183 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5184
5185http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186
5187 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5188 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5189 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5190 example, or to pass some internal information.
5191 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5192 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5193 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5194
5195http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5196
5197 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5198 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5199
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005200http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005201
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005202 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5203 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5204 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5205 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5206 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005207
5208http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5209 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5210
5211 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5212
5213 Example:
5214 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5215
5216 # applied to:
5217 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5218
5219 # outputs:
5220 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5221
5222 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5223
5224http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5225 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5226
5227 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5228
5229 Example:
5230 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5231
5232 # applied to:
5233 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5234
5235 # outputs:
5236 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5237
5238http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5239
5240 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5241 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5242 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5243
5244http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5245 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5246
5247 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5248 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5249 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5250 fallback.
5251
5252 Example:
5253 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5254 http-response set-status 431
5255 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5256 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5257
5258http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5259
5260 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5261 inline.
5262
5263 Arguments:
5264 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5265 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5266 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5267 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5268 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5269 (request and response)
5270 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5271 processing
5272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5273 processing
5274 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5275 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5276 and '_'.
5277
5278 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5279 followed by some converters.
5280
5281 Example:
5282 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5283
5284http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5285
5286 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5287 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5288 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5289 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5290 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005291 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005292 processing.
5293
5294 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5295 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005296 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005297 rules evaluation.
5298
5299http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5300
5301 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5302 details about <var-name>.
5303
5304 Example:
5305 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5306
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005307
5308http-check comment <string>
5309 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5310 it fails.
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 yes | no | yes | yes
5313
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005314 Arguments :
5315 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5316 rule fails.
5317
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005318 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5319 user-friendly error reporting.
5320
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005321 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005322 "http-check expect".
5323
5324
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005325http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5326 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005327 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005328 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5330 yes | no | yes | yes
5331
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005332 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005333 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5334
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005335 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005336 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005337
5338 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5339 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5340 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5341 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5342
5343 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5344
5345 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5346
5347 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5348
5349 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5350
5351 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5352
5353 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5354 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5355 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5356 is used.
5357
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005358 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5359 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5360 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5361 haproxy -vv.
5362
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005363 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5364
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005365 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5366 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5367 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5368 different ports or with different servers.
5369
5370 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5371 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5372 the port with a "http-check connect".
5373
5374 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5375 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5376 do.
5377
5378 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5379 unset-var or comment rules.
5380
5381 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005382 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5383 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5384 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5385 option httpchk
5386
5387 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005388 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005389 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005391 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005392 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005393
5394 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5395
5396 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005397
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005399http-check disable-on-404
5400 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005402 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005403 Arguments : none
5404
5405 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5406 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5407 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5408 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5409 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5410 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5411 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5412 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005413 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5414 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005415 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5416 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5417 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005419 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005420
5421
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005422http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005423 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5424 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5425 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005426 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005428 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005429
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005430 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005431 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5432
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005433 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5434 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5435 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5436 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5437 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5438 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5439 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5440 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5441 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5442 result is always conclusive.
5443
5444 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5445 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5446 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005447 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5448 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005449 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5450 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005451 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5452 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5453 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454
5455 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5456 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005457 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5458 supported :
5459 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5460 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005461 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5462 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5463 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5464 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5465 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466
5467 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5468 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005469 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5470 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5471 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5472 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005473 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5474
5475 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5476 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5477 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5478 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5479
5480 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5481 informational message reported in logs if an error
5482 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5483 log-format string.
5484
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005485 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005486 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5487 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005488 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5489 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5490 details on the supported keywords.
5491
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005492 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5493 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5494 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5495 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005496
5497 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5498 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5499 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5500 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5501 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5502
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005503 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5504 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5505 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5506 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5507 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5508 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5509 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005510
5511 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005512 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005513 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5514 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5515 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5516 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5517
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005518 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5519 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005520 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5521 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5522 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5523 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5524 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5525 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5526 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5527 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005528 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5529 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5530 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5531 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5532 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5533 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5534 insensitive on the header names.
5535
5536 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5537 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5538 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5539 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5540 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5541 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005542
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005544 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005545 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5546 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5547 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5548 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5549 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005550 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005551 trace).
5552
5553 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005554 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005555 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5556 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5557 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5558 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5559 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005560 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005561
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005562 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5563 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5564 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5565 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5566 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5567 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5568
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005570 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005571 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5572 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5573 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5574 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5575 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5576 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5577
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005578 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5579 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5580 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5581 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5582 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005583
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005584 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5585 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5586
5587 Examples :
5588 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005589 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005590
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005591 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5592 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5593
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005594 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005595 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005596
5597 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005598 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005599
5600 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005601 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005602
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005604 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005605
5606
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005607http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005608 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5609 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005610 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5611 health checks.
5612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 yes | no | yes | yes
5614 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005615 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5616
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005617 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5618 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5619 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5620 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5621 to invent non-standard ones.
5622
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005623 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5624 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5625 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5626 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5627
5628 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5629 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5630 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5631 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005632
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005633 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005634 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005635 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005636 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5637 to add it.
5638
5639 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5640 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5641 to the log-format rules.
5642
5643 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5644 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5645 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005646
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005647 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5648 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5649 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5650 request.
5651
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005652 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5653 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5654 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005655 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5656 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5657 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5658 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005659 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005660
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005661 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005662 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5663 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005664
5665 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5666 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5667 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5668 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5669 configured request authority.
5670
5671 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5672 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005673
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005674 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005675
5676
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005677http-check send-state
5678 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | no | yes | yes
5681 Arguments : none
5682
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005683 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005684 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005685 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5686 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5687 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005688
5689 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5690 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5691 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5692 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5693 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005694 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5695 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5696 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5697
5698 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5699 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5700 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5701
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005702 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5703 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5704 checked in multiple backends.
5705
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005706 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005707 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5708
5709 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5710 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5711 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5712 one fails.
5713
5714 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5715 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5716 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5717
5718 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5719 server's queue.
5720
5721 Example of a header received by the application server :
5722 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5723 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005725 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5726 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005727
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728
5729http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5732 yes | no | yes | yes
5733
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5736 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5739 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5740 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5741 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5742 and '-'.
5743
5744 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5745
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005746 Examples :
5747 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005748
5749
5750http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005751 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5753 yes | no | yes | yes
5754
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005755 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5757 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5758 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5759 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5760 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5761 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5762 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5763 and '-'.
5764
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005765 Examples :
5766 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005769http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5770 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5771 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5772 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5773 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | yes | yes | yes
5776 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005777 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005778 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005779 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005780 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005781
5782 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5783 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5784 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5785 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5786
5787 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5788 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5789 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5790 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5791
5792 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5793 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5794 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5795 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5796 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5797 chroot is performed.
5798
5799 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5800 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5801 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5802 considered.
5803
5804 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5805 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5806 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5807 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5808 considered as a raw string.
5809
5810 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5811 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5812 "content-type".
5813
5814 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5815 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5816 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5817 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5818 evaluated as a log-format string.
5819
5820 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5821 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5822 argument to "content-type".
5823
5824 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5825 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5826 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5827 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5828
5829 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5830 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5831 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5832 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5833 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5834 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5835 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5836 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5837
5838 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5839 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5840 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5841
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005842 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5843 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5844 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5845 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5846 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5847
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005848 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5849 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5850
5851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005852http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005853 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5854
5855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 no | yes | yes | yes
5857
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005858 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5859 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5860 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5861 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5862 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005864 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5865 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005867 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869 Example:
5870 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5871 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5872 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874 http-request allow if nagios
5875 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5876 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5877 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005879 Example:
5880 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5881 acl add path /addacl
5882 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5887 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005889 Example:
5890 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5891 acl setmap path /setmap
5892 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005896 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5897 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5900 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005902http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5905 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5906 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5907 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5908 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5909 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5910 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5911 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005913http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5916 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5917 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5918 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5919 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5920 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5921 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5922 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005924http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005926 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5927 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005931
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005932 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5933 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5934 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5935 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5936 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005937
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005938 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5939 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5940 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5941 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5942 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5943 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5944 instead.
5945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 Example:
5947 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5948 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005950http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005951
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005952 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005954http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5955 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005957 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5958 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5959 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5960 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5961 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5962 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5963 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5964 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5965 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005967 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5968 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5969 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005970 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5971
5972 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5973 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5974 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5975 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005977http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005979 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5980 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5981 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5982 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5983 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5984 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005985
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005986http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005987
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005988 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5989 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5990 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5991 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5992 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005996 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5997 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5998 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5999 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6000 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6001 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006002
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006003http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6005 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6006 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6007 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006009
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006010 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6011 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6012 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006013 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006014 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6015 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6016 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006017 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006018 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006019
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006020http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6021 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6022 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6023 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6024
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006025http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6026
6027 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6028 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6029 pointed by <resolvers>.
6030 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6031 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6032 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6033 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6034 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6035 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6036 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6037 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6038 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6039 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6040 to 0.0.0.0.
6041
6042 Example:
6043 resolvers mydns
6044 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6045 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6046 timeout retry 1s
6047 hold valid 10s
6048 hold nx 3s
6049 hold other 3s
6050 hold obsolete 0s
6051 accepted_payload_size 8192
6052
6053 frontend fe
6054 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6055 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6056 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6057
6058 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6059 # which mean DNS resolution error
6060 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6061
6062 default_backend be
6063
6064 backend b_503
6065 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6066 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6067 # 503 error page to end users
6068
6069 backend be
6070 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6071 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6072 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6073 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6074 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6075
6076 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6077 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6078
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006079http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080
6081 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6082 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6083 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6084 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006085 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6086 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006087
6088 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6089
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006090http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006091http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006092http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006093http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006094http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006095http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006096http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006097http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6098http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006099
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006100 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6101
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006102 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006103 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6104 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6105 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6106 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006107
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006108 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6109 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6110 the supported backend.
6111
6112 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6113 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6114 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6115 number of segments in the path.
6116
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006117 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6118 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6119 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6120 when improperly combined.
6121
6122 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6123 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6124 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6125 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6126 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6127
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006128 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006129
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006130 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6131
6132 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6133 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6134
6135 Example:
6136 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6137
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006138 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6139
6140 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6141 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6142
6143 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6144 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6145
6146 Example:
6147 - /#foo -> /
6148
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006149 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6150 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006151
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006152 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6153 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6154
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006155 Example:
6156 - /. -> /
6157 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6158 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6159 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006160
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006161 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6162 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6163
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006164 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006165 their preceding segment.
6166
6167 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6168 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6169
6170 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6171 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006172
6173 Example:
6174 - /foo/../ -> /
6175 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6176 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6177 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006178 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006179 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006180 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006181
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006182 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6183 removed as well:
6184
6185 Example:
6186 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6187 - /bar/../../ -> /
6188
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006189 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6190 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006191
6192 Example:
6193 - // -> /
6194 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6195
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006196 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6197 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6198
6199 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6200 ".", "_", and "~".
6201
6202 Example:
6203 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6204 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6205 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6206 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6207
6208 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6209 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6210
6211 Example:
6212 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6213 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6214
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006215 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006216 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006217
6218 Example:
6219 - /%6f -> /%6F
6220 - /%zz -> /%zz
6221
6222 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6223 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6224
6225 Example:
6226 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6227
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006229 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6230 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6231
6232 Example:
6233 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6234 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6235 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006237http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006239 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6240 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6241 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6242 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6243 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006245http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006247 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6248 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6249 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6250 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6253 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006254
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006255 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006256 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6257 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6258 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6259 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6260 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006261
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006262 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6263 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6264 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6265 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6266 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006267
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006268 Example:
6269 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6270
6271 # applied to:
6272 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6273
6274 # outputs:
6275 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6276
6277 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006278
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006279 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6280
6281 # applied to:
6282 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006283
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006284 # outputs:
6285 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006286
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006287http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6289
6290 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6291 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006292 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6293 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6294 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006295
6296 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6297 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6298 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6299
6300 Example:
6301 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6302 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6303
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006304 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6305 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6306 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6307 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6308
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006309http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6311
6312 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6313 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6314 query-string are replaced.
6315
6316 Example:
6317 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6318 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6319
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006320http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006323 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6324 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6325 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6326 against.
6327
6328 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6329 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6330 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006331
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006332 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6333 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6334 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6335 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6336 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6337 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6338 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6339 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6340 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006341 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6342 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006343
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006344 Example:
6345 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6346 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006347
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006348 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6349 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006351http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6352 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006353
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006354 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6355 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6356 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6357 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006358
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006359 Example:
6360 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006361
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006362 # applied to:
6363 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006364
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006365 # outputs:
6366 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006367
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006368http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6369 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6370 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006371 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6373
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006374 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006375 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6376 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006377 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006378 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006379 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006380 are followed to create the response :
6381
6382 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6383 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6384 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6385 ignored.
6386
6387 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6388 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006389 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006390 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6391 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006392
6393 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6394 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6395 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006396 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006397 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006398
6399 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6400 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6401 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006402 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006403 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006404 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006405
6406 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6407 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6408 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6409 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6410 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6411 as a raw content.
6412
6413 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6414 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6415 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6416 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6417 considered as a raw string.
6418
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006419 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006420 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6421 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6422 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6423
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006424 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6425 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006426 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006427
6428 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6429
6430 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006431 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006432 if { path /ping }
6433
6434 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6435 if { path /favicon.ico }
6436
6437 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6438 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6439 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6440
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006441http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6444 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6445 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6446 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6447 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6448 at this index.
6449 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6450 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006452http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006455 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6456 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6457 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006458
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006459http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6460 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6461 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6462 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6463 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6464 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6465 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6466 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6467 at this index.
6468 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6469 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6470
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006471http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6472 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006473
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006474 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6475 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6476 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6477 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006479http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006481 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6482 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6483 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6484 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6485 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487 Arguments:
6488 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6489 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006491 Example:
6492 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6493 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6496 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006500 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6501 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6502 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006504 Arguments:
6505 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6506 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006508 Example:
6509 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6510 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006512 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6513 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6514 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006516http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006518 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6519 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6520 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6521 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6522 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524 Example:
6525 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6526 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6527 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6528 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6530 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6531 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6538 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6539 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6540 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6541 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006543http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6544 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006546 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6547 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6548 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6549 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6550 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6551 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6552 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6553 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6554 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006556http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006557
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006558 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6559 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6560 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6561 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6562 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6563 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6564 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006565 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6566 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6571 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6572 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006576 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6577 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6578 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6579 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6580 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6581 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6582 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6583 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006584
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006585http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6588 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6589 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6590 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6591 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6592 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 Example :
6595 # prepend the host name before the path
6596 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006597
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006598http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6599
6600 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6601 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6602 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6607 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6608 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6609 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6610 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6615 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6616 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6617 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6618 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6619 values have higher priority.
6620 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6621 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6622 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6623 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6624 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6629 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6630 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6631 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6632 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6633 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6634 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006637
6638 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6640 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6643 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6644 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6645 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006646 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6647 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648
6649 Arguments :
6650 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6651 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006652
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006653 See also "option forwardfor".
6654
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006655 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6657 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6658
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006659 # After the masking this will track connections
6660 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6661 http-request track-sc0 src
6662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6664 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6665
6666http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6667
6668 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6669 expression.
6670
6671 Arguments:
6672 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6673 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006674
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6677 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6678
6679 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6680 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6681 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6682
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006683http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006684 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6685
6686 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6687 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6688 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6689 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6690 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6691
6692 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6693 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6694 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6695 results.
6696
6697 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006698 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6699 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006701http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6702
6703 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6704 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6705 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6706 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6707 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6708 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6709 information from the request.
6710
6711 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6712
6713http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6714
6715 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6716 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6717 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6718 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6719 path and the query string.
6720 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6721
6722http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6723
6724 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6725 inline.
6726
6727 Arguments:
6728 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6729 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6733 (request and response)
6734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6735 processing
6736 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6737 processing
6738 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6739 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6740 and '_'.
6741
6742 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6743 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006744
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006745 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6749 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006751 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6752 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6753 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6754 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6755 agent name must be used.
6756
6757 Arguments:
6758 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6759
6760 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6761 configuration.
6762
6763http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6764
6765 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6766 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6767 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6768 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6769 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6770 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6771 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6772 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6773 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6774 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6775 action.
6776 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6777 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6778 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6779 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6780 you fully understand how it works.
6781
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006782http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6783
6784 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6785 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6786 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6787 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6788 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006789 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006790 processing.
6791
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006792 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006793 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6794 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6795 rules evaluation.
6796
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006797http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6798http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6799 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6800 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6801 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6802 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006803
6804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6805 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6806 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006807 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6808 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6809 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6810 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6811 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6812 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006813 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006814 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6815 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6816 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006817 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006818 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6819 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6820 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6821 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6822 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006823
6824http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6826http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827
6828 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6829 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6830 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6831 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006832 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6834 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6835 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6836 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6837 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6838 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6839 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6840
6841 Arguments :
6842 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6843 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6844 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6845 select which table entry to update the counters.
6846
6847 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6848 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6849 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6850 that table until the session ends.
6851
6852 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6853 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6854 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6855 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6856 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6857 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6858 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6859 useful information.
6860
6861 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6862 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6863 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6864 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6865 checks that make use of it.
6866
6867http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6868
6869 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006870
6871 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006872 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006873
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006874http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6875
6876 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6877 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6878 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6879 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6880 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6881 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6882
6883 Arguments :
6884 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6885
6886 Example:
6887 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6888
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006889http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6890 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6891
6892 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6893 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6894 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6895 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6896 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6897 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6898 http-buffer-request".
6899
6900 Arguments :
6901
6902 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6903 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6904
6905 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006906 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006907 bytes.
6908
6909 Example:
6910 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6911
6912 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006914http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006916 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6917 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6918 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006919
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006921http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006922 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6923
6924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 no | yes | yes | yes
6926
6927 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6928 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6929 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6930 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6931 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6932 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006934 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6935 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006937 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006939 Example:
6940 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006942 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6945 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947 Example:
6948 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006950 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006952 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6953 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006955 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6956 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6961 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6962 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6963 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6964 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6965 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6966 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6967 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006969http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006971 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6972 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6973 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6974 example, or to pass some internal information.
6975 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6976 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6977 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6982 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006984http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006986 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006990 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6991 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6992 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6993 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6994 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6995 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6996 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6999 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7000 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7001 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7002 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007003
7004 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7005 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7006 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7007 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007009http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7012 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7013 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7014 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7015 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7016 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007017
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007018http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007019
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007020 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7021 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7022 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7023 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7024 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007025
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007026http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7029 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7030 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7031 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7032 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7033 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007034
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007035http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7036http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7037 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7038 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7039 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7040 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007041
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007042 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7043 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7044 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007045 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007046 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7047 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7048 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007049 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007050 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7055 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7056 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7057 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7058 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7059 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007063
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007064 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7065 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 Example:
7068 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070 # applied to:
7071 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073 # outputs:
7074 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007080
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007081 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007082 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 Example:
7085 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 # applied to:
7088 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 # outputs:
7091 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007092
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007093http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7094 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7095 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007096 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007097 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7098
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007099 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007100 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7101 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007102 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007103 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007104 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007105 are followed to create the response :
7106
7107 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7108 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7109 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7110 ignored.
7111
7112 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7113 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007114 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007115 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7116 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007117
7118 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7119 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7120 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007121 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007122 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123
7124 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7125 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7126 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007127 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007128 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007129 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007130
7131 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7132 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7133 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7134 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7135 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7136 as a raw content.
7137
7138 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7139 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7140 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7141 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7142 considered as a raw string.
7143
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007144 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7145 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7146 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7147 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7148
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007149 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7150 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007151 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007152
7153 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7154
7155 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007156 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007157 if { status eq 404 }
7158
7159 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7160 string "This is the end !" \
7161 if { status eq 500 }
7162
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007163http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7164
7165 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7166 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7167 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7168 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7169 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7170 at this index.
7171 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7172 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007174http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7175http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007177 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7178 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7179 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007180
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007181http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7182 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7183
7184 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7185 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7186 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7187 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7188 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7189 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7190 at this index.
7191 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7192 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7193
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007194http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7195 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007196
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007197 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7198 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7199 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7200 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7205 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7206 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7207 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7208 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 Arguments:
7211 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007213 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7214 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7219 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7220 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7223
7224 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7225 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7226 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7227 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7228 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7229
7230http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7231
7232 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7233 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7234 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7235 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7236 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7237 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7238 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7239 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7240 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7241
7242http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7243
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007244 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7245 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7246 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7247 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7248 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7249 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7250 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007251 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7252 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007253
7254http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7255
7256 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7257 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7258 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7259 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7260 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7261 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7262 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7263 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7264
7265http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7266 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7267
7268 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7269 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7270 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7271 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007272
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007273 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007274 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7275 http-response set-status 431
7276 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7277 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007279http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007281 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7282 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7283 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7284 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7285 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7286 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7287 based on some information from the request.
7288
7289 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7290
7291http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7292
7293 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7294 inline.
7295
7296 Arguments:
7297 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7298 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7302 (request and response)
7303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7304 processing
7305 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7306 processing
7307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7308 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7309 and '_'.
7310
7311 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7312 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007313
7314 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007319 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7320 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7321 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7322 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7323 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7324 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7325 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7326 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7327 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7328 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7329 action.
7330 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7331 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7332 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7333 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7334 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007335
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007336http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7337
7338 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7339 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7340 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7341 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7342 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007343 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007344 processing.
7345
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007346 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007347 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007348 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007349 rules evaluation.
7350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007351http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7352http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7353http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7356 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7357 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7358 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7359 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007360 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361
7362http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7363
7364 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7365 about <var-name>.
7366
7367 Example:
7368 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7369
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007370http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7372
7373 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7374 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7375 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7376 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7377 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7378 buffer is full.
7379
7380 Arguments :
7381
7382 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7383 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7384
7385 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007386 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007387 bytes.
7388
7389 Example:
7390 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007391
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007392http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7393 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7394
7395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7396 yes | no | yes | yes
7397
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007398 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007399 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7400 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7401 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007402
7403 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7404
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007405 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7406 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7407 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7408 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7409 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7410 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7411 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007412 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007413 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7414 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007415
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007416 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7417 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7418 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7419 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7420 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7421 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7422 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007423 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7424 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7425 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7426 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7427 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7428 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007429
7430 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7431 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7432 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7433 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7434 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7435 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7436 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7437 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007438 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007439 downsides of rare connection failures.
7440
7441 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7442 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7443 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7444 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7445 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7446 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007447 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007448 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7449 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7450 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7451 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7452 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7453
7454 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007455 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7456 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7457 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7458 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007459
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007460 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7461 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007463 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007464
7465 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7466 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7467 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7468
7469 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7470
7471
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007472http-send-name-header [<header>]
7473 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007476 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007477 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7478
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007479 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7480 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7481 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7482 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7483 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7484 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7485 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7486 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7487 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7488 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7489 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7490 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7491 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7492 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7493 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7494 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007495
7496 See also : "server"
7497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007498id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007499 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7501 no | yes | yes | yes
7502 Arguments : none
7503
7504 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7505 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7506 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007507
7508
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007509ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7510 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007512 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007513
7514 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7515 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7516 and running).
7517
7518 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7519 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7520 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007521 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007522 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7523
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007524 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7525 "unless" condition is met.
7526
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007527 Example:
7528 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7529 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7530 ignore-persist if url_static
7531
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007532 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7533
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007534load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7535 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7537 yes | no | yes | yes
7538
7539 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7540 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7541 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007542 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007543 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007544 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7545 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7546 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007548 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007549 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007550 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007551
7552 Arguments:
7553 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7554 named "server-state-file".
7555
7556 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7557 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7558 name is used as a file name.
7559
7560 none don't load any stat for this backend
7561
7562 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007563 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7564 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7565 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007566 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007567 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007568
7569 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7570 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007572 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007573
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007574 global
7575 stats socket /tmp/socket
7576 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007578 defaults
7579 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007580
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007581 backend bk
7582 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7583 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007584
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007585
7586 Then one can run :
7587
7588 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7589
7590 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7591
7592 1
7593 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7594 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7595 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7596
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007597 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007598
7599 global
7600 stats socket /tmp/socket
7601 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7602
7603 defaults
7604 load-server-state-from-file local
7605
7606 backend bk
7607 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7608 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7609
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007610
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007611 Then one can run :
7612
7613 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7614
7615 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7616
7617 1
7618 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7619 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7620 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7621
7622 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7623 "show servers state"
7624
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007626log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007627log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007628 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007629no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007630 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7632 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007633
7634 Prefix :
7635 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7636 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7637 prefix does not allow arguments.
7638
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007639 Arguments :
7640 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7641 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7642 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7643 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7644 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7645 parameter.
7646
7647 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7648 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7649
7650 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7651 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7652 standard syslog port).
7653
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007654 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7655 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7656 standard syslog port).
7657
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007658 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7659 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7660 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007661 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007662
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007663 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7664 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7665 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7666 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7667 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7668 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7669 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7670 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7671 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7672 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7673 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7674 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007675 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007676 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7677 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7678 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007679 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7680 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007681
7682 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7683 and "fd@2", see above.
7684
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007685 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7686 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7687 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7688 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7689 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7690 having the logs instantly available.
7691
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007692 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7693 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7694 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7695
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007696 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7697 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007698
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007699 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7700 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7701 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7702 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7703 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7704 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7705 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7706 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7707 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7708 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007709 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007710
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007711 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7712 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7713 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7714 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7715 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7716
7717 <sample_size>
7718 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7719 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7720 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7721 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7722 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7723
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007724 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7725 one of the following :
7726
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007727 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7728 field is stripped. This is the default.
7729 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7730 rfc3164.
7731
7732 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007733 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7734
7735 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7736 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7737
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007738 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7739 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7740 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7741 designed to be used with a local log server.
7742
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007743 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7744 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7745 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7746 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7747 systemd logger consumes.
7748
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007749 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7750 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7751 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7752 used with a local log server.
7753
7754 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7755 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7756 designed to be used with a local log server.
7757
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007758 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7759 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7760 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7761 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007763 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7764
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007765 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7766 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7767 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7768
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007769 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7770 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7771 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7772 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007773
7774 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7775 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7776 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007777 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7778 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7779 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7780 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7781 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007782
7783 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7784
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007785 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7786 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7787 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007788
7789 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7790 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7791 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7792 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7793
7794 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7795 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007796
7797 Example :
7798 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007799 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7800 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7801 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007802 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007803 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7804 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007805 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007806
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007807
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007808log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007809 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7811 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007812
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007813 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7814 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7815 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7816 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7817 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007818
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007819 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7820 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007821
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007822log-format-sd <string>
7823 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | yes | yes | no
7826
7827 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7828 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7829 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7830 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7831 which covers the log format string in depth.
7832
7833 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7834 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7835
7836 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7837 log format to "rfc5424".
7838
7839 Example :
7840 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7841
7842
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007843log-tag <string>
7844 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | yes | yes | yes
7847
7848 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7849 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007850 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007851 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7852 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7853 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7854 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7855 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7856 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007857
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007858max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7859 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | no | yes | yes
7862
7863 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7864 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7865 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7866 servers.
7867
7868 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007869 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007870 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7871 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7872 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007873 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007874 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7875 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7876 picking a different server.
7877
7878 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7879 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7880 even if they have to be queued.
7881
7882 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7883 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7884
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007885max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7886 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7887 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7888 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007889
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890maxconn <conns>
7891 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7893 yes | yes | yes | no
7894 Arguments :
7895 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7896 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7897 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7898 closes.
7899
7900 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007901 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007902 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7903 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007904 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7905 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7906 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7907 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007908
7909 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7910 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7911 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7912
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007913 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7914 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007915
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007916 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7917
7918
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007919mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007920 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 yes | yes | yes | yes
7923 Arguments :
7924 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7925 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7926 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7927 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7928
7929 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7930 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7931 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7932 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7933 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7934
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007935 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7936 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7937 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007938
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007939 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007940 defaults http_instances
7941 mode http
7942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007944monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007945 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7947 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007948 Arguments :
7949 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7950 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007951 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007952 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7953 backend and its backup.
7954
7955 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7956 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7957 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7958 servers in a list of backends.
7959
7960 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7961 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7962 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007963 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007964 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7965 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007966 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007967 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7968 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007969
7970 Example:
7971 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007972 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007973 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7974 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7975 monitor-uri /site_alive
7976 monitor fail if site_dead
7977
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007978 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007979
7980
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007981monitor-uri <uri>
7982 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7984 yes | yes | yes | no
7985 Arguments :
7986 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7987 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7988
7989 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7990 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7991 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7992 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7993 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7994 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7995 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7996 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7997
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007998 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007999 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8000 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8001 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8002 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8003 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8004 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008005
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008006 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8007 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8008 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8009 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8010
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008011 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008012 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008013 frontend www
8014 mode http
8015 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8016
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008017 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008019
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008020option abortonclose
8021no option abortonclose
8022 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | no | yes | yes
8025 Arguments : none
8026
8027 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8028 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8029 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8030 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008031 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008032 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8033 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8034 encountered while delivering the response.
8035
8036 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8037 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8038 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8039 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8040 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8041 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008042 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008043 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008044 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008045 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8046 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8047 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008049 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8050 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008051 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8052 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8053 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8054 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8055 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8056 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008057 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008058
8059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8061
8062 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8063
8064
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008065option accept-invalid-http-request
8066no option accept-invalid-http-request
8067 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8069 yes | yes | yes | no
8070 Arguments : none
8071
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008072 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008073 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008074 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008075 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8076 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8077 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8078 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8079 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008080 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8081 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8082 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8083 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008084 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008085 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008086 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8087 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8088 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008089
8090 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8091 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8092 been confirmed.
8093
8094 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8095 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008096 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8097 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008098 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8099
8100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8102
8103 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8104 stats socket.
8105
8106
8107option accept-invalid-http-response
8108no option accept-invalid-http-response
8109 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 yes | no | yes | yes
8112 Arguments : none
8113
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008114 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008115 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008116 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008117 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8118 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8119 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8120 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8121 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008122 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8123 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8124 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008125
8126 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8127 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8128 been confirmed.
8129
8130 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8131 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8132 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8133 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8134
8135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8137
8138 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8139 stats socket.
8140
8141
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008142option allbackups
8143no option allbackups
8144 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 yes | no | yes | yes
8147 Arguments : none
8148
8149 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8150 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8151 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8152 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8153 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8154 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8155 order between the backup servers anymore.
8156
8157 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8158 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8159
8160 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8161 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8162
8163
8164option checkcache
8165no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008166 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8168 yes | no | yes | yes
8169 Arguments : none
8170
8171 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8172 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008173 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008174 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8175 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008176 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008177
8178 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008179 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008180 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008181 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8182 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008183 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008184 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008185 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8186 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008187 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008188 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8189 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008191 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8192 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8193 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8194 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8195 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8197 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8198 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8199 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8200
8201 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008202 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8203 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8204 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8205 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008206
8207 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8208 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008209 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008210 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008211
8212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8214
8215
8216option clitcpka
8217no option clitcpka
8218 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 yes | yes | yes | no
8221 Arguments : none
8222
8223 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8224 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008225 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008226 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8227
8228 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8229 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8230 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8231 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8232
8233 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8234 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8235 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8236 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8237 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8238
8239 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8240
8241 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8242 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8243 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8244
8245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8247
8248 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8249
8250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008251option contstats
8252 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 yes | yes | yes | no
8255 Arguments : none
8256
8257 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8258 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8259 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008260 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008261 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8262 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8263 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8264 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8265 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008266
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008267option disable-h2-upgrade
8268no option disable-h2-upgrade
8269 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8270 connection.
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 yes | yes | yes | no
8273 Arguments : none
8274
8275 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8276 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8277 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8278 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008279 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8280 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8281 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8282 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8283 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8284 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008285
8286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008288
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008289option dontlog-normal
8290no option dontlog-normal
8291 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | yes | yes | no
8294 Arguments : none
8295
8296 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8297 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8298 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8299 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8300 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8301 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8302 logged.
8303
8304 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8305 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8306 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008308 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008309 logging.
8310
8311
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008312option dontlognull
8313no option dontlognull
8314 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8316 yes | yes | yes | no
8317 Arguments : none
8318
8319 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8320 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8321 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8322 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8323 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8324 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008325 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8326 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8327 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008328
8329 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008331 would not be logged.
8332
8333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8335
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008336 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008337 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008338
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008339
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008340option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008341 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | yes | yes | yes
8344 Arguments :
8345 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8346 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008347 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008348 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008349
8350 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8351 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8352 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8353 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8354 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8355 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8356 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008357 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8358 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8359 possible that the client has already brought one.
8360
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008361 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008362 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008364 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008365 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008366 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008367
8368 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8369 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8370 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8371 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8372 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8373 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008374 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008375
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008376 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8377 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008378 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008379 are under the control of the end-user.
8380
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008381 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008382 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8383 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008384 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8385 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8386 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008387
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008388 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008389 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8390 frontend www
8391 mode http
8392 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8393
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008394 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8395 backend www
8396 mode http
8397 option forwardfor header X-Client
8398
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008399 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008400 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008401
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008402
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008403option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8404no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8405 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 yes | yes | yes | no
8408 Arguments : none
8409
8410 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8411 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8412 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8413 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8414 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8415 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8416 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8417
8418 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8419 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8420 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8421 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8422 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8423 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8424 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8425 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8426 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8427 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8428
8429 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8430
8431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8433
8434 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8435 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8436
8437
8438option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8439no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8440 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | no | yes | yes
8443 Arguments : none
8444
8445 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8446 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8447 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8448 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8449 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8450 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8451 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8452
8453 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8454 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8455 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8456 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8457 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8458 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8459 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8460 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8461 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8462 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8463
8464 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8465
8466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8468
8469 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8470 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8471
8472
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008473option http-buffer-request
8474no option http-buffer-request
8475 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8477 yes | yes | yes | yes
8478 Arguments : none
8479
8480 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8481 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8482 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8483 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8484 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8485 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008486 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8487 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8488 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8489 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008490
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008491 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8492 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008493
8494
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008495option http-ignore-probes
8496no option http-ignore-probes
8497 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8499 yes | yes | yes | no
8500 Arguments : none
8501
8502 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8503 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8504 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8505 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8506 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8507 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8508 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8509 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8510 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008511 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8512 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008513 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8514
8515 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8516 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8517 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8518 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8519 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8520 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8521 are often the only way to detect them.
8522
8523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8525
8526 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8527
8528
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008529option http-keep-alive
8530no option http-keep-alive
8531 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8533 yes | yes | yes | yes
8534 Arguments : none
8535
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008536 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8537 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008538 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8539 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008540 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8541 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8542 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008543
8544 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8545 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008546 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8547 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8548 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8549 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8550 situations where this option may be useful :
8551
8552 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008553 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008554
8555 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8556 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8557
8558 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8559 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8560 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8561 request.
8562
8563 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8564 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008565 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8566 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8567 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008568
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008569 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8570 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8571 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8572 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8573 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8574 not set.
8575
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008576 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8577 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8578 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008579
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008580 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008581 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008582 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008583
8584
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008585option http-no-delay
8586no option http-no-delay
8587 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8589 yes | yes | yes | yes
8590 Arguments : none
8591
8592 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8593 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8594 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8595 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8596 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8597 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8598 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008599 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008600 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8601 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8602 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8603 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8604 affected.
8605
8606 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8607 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8608 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8609 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8610 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8611 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8612 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8613 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8614 latency environments.
8615
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008616 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8617
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008618
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008619option http-pretend-keepalive
8620no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008621 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008623 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008624 Arguments : none
8625
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008626 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008627 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8628 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8629 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008630 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008631 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8632 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8633 consider the response complete.
8634
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008635 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008636 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008637 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008638 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008639 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008640 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8641
8642 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8643 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8644 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8645 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008646 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8647 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008648 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8649
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008650 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8651 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8652 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8653 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8654 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8655 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008656
8657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8659
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008660 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008661 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008662
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008663
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008664option http-server-close
8665no option http-server-close
8666 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | yes | yes | yes
8669 Arguments : none
8670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8672 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8673 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8674 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008675 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8676 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8677 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8678 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8679 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8680 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8681 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8682 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8683 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8684 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8685 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008686
8687 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8688 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8689 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8690 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008691 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8692 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008693
8694 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8695 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008696 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8697 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8698 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008699
8700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8702
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008703 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8704 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008705
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008706option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008707no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008708 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8710 yes | yes | yes | no
8711 Arguments : none
8712
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008713 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008714 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8715 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8716 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8717 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8718 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008719 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008720
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008721 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008722 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008723 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8724 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8725 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008726
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008727 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8728 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8729 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8730 front of an existing proxy.
8731
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008732 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8733
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008734 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008736option httpchk
8737option httpchk <uri>
8738option httpchk <method> <uri>
8739option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008740 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8742 yes | no | yes | yes
8743 Arguments :
8744 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8745 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8746 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8747 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8748 ones.
8749
8750 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8751 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8752 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8753
8754 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8755 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8756 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008757 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008758
8759 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8760 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8761 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8762 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8763 the lack of any response.
8764
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008765 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8766 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8767 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8768 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8769
8770 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8771 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8772 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008773
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008774 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8775 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008776 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008777 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008778 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008779
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008780 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8781 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8782 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8783 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8784
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008785 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008786 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8787 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8788 backend https_relay
8789 mode tcp
8790 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8791 http-check send hdr Host www
8792 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008793
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008794 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8795 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8796 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008797
8798
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008799option httpclose
8800no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008801 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8803 yes | yes | yes | yes
8804 Arguments : none
8805
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008806 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8807 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8808 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8809 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008810 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008811
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008812 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8813 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008814 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008815 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8816 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008817
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008818 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8819 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8820 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008821
8822 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8823 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008824 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8825 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8826 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008827
8828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8830
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008831 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008832
8833
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008834option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008835 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008837 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008838 Arguments :
8839 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8840 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8841 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008842 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008843 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008844
8845 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8846 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8847 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8848 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8849 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8850 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8851 ports.
8852
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008853 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8854 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008855
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008856 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008858 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008859
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008860option httpslog
8861 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8863 yes | yes | yes | no
8864
8865 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8866 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8867 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8868 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8869 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8870 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8871 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8872
8873 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8874
8875 See also : section 8 about logging.
8876
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008877
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008878option independent-streams
8879no option independent-streams
8880 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8882 yes | yes | yes | yes
8883 Arguments : none
8884
8885 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8886 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8887 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8888 receive data or not.
8889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008890 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008891 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8892 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8893 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8894 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8895 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8896 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8897 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8898 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8899 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8900 socket buffers.
8901
8902 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8903 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8904 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8905 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8906 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8907
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008908 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008909
8910
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008911option ldap-check
8912 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8914 yes | no | yes | yes
8915 Arguments : none
8916
8917 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8918 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8919 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8920 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8921
8922 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8923 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8924
8925 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8926 configure it.
8927
8928 Example :
8929 option ldap-check
8930
8931 See also : "option httpchk"
8932
8933
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008934option external-check
8935 Use external processes for server health checks
8936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8937 yes | no | yes | yes
8938
8939 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8940 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8941 command".
8942
8943 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8944
8945 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8946
8947
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008948option log-health-checks
8949no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008950 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8952 yes | no | yes | yes
8953 Arguments : none
8954
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008955 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8956 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8957 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008958
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008959 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8960 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8961 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8962 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8963 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8964
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008965 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008966 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008967
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008968 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8969 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8970 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008971
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008972
8973option log-separate-errors
8974no option log-separate-errors
8975 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8977 yes | yes | yes | no
8978 Arguments : none
8979
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008980 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008981 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8982 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8983 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8984 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8985 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8986 provides very important information.
8987
8988 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8989 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8990 error logs.
8991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008992 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008993 logging.
8994
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008995
8996option logasap
8997no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008998 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9000 yes | yes | yes | no
9001 Arguments : none
9002
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009003 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9004 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9005 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9006 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9007
9008 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9009 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9010 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9011 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9012 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009013 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009014 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9015 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9016 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9017 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009018 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009020 Examples :
9021 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9022 mode http
9023 option httplog
9024 option logasap
9025 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9026
9027 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9028 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9029 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9030 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009032 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009033 logging.
9034
9035
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +02009036option log-error-via-logformat
9037no option log-error-via-logformat
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +02009038 Enable or disable dedicated connection error logging.
9039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9040 yes | yes | yes | no
9041 Arguments : none
9042
9043 In case of connection error, if the option is disabled, a log line following
9044 the format described in section 8.2.6, the legacy format, will be emitted.
9045 Otherwise, a log line following the configured log-format for the listener
9046 will be emitted. The error code and the corresponding message found in the
9047 error log can be added to a log-format thanks to the "fc_conn_err" and
9048 "fc_conn_err_str" sample fetches.
9049
9050 See also : "option httpslog" and section 8 about logging.
9051
9052
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009053option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009054 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009057 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009058 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9059 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009060 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9061 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009062
9063 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9064 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009066 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009067 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9068 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9069 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009070
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009071 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9072 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9073 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009074
9075 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009077 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9078 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9079 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9080 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9081 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9082 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9083 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9084
9085 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9086 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009087
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009088 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009089
9090 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9091 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9092 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9093 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009094 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009095 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009096
9097 See also: "option httpchk"
9098
9099
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009100option nolinger
9101no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009102 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009103 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009105 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009106
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009107 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009108 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9109 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9110 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9111 connections.
9112
9113 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9114 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009115 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9116 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9117 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9118 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9119 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9120 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9121 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9122 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9123 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9124 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9125 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9126 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9127 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009128
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009129 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9130 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9131 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9132 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9133 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009134
9135 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9136 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009137 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009138 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009139 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140
9141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9143
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009144 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9145 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009147option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9148 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9150 yes | yes | yes | yes
9151 Arguments :
9152 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9153 matching <network>
9154 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9155 header name.
9156
9157 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9158 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9159 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9160 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9161 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9162 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9163 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9164 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9165 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9166 possible that the client has already brought one.
9167
9168 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9169 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9170 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9171 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9172 header and requires different one.
9173
9174 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9175 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9176 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009177 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9178 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9179 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9180 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9181 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009182
9183 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9184 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9185 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9186 both are defined.
9187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009188 Examples :
9189 # Original Destination address
9190 frontend www
9191 mode http
9192 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9193
9194 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9195 backend www
9196 mode http
9197 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009199 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009200
9201
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009202option persist
9203no option persist
9204 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9206 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009207 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009208
9209 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9210 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9211 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9212 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9213 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9214 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9215 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9216 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9217 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9218 redirected to another valid server.
9219
9220 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9221 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9222
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009223 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009224
9225
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009226option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9227 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9229 yes | no | yes | yes
9230 Arguments :
9231 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9232 PostgreSQL server.
9233
9234 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9235 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9236 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9237 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9238
9239 See also: "option httpchk"
9240
9241
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009242option prefer-last-server
9243no option prefer-last-server
9244 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9246 yes | no | yes | yes
9247 Arguments : none
9248
9249 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009250 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009251 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9252 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009253 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009254 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009255 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009256 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9257 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009258 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009259 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009260 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9261 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9262 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009263 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9264 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9265 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009266
9267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9269
9270 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9271
9272
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009273option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009274option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009275no option redispatch
9276 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009279 Arguments :
9280 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9281 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9282 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009283 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009284 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009285 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009286 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9287 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9288 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009290
9291 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9292 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9293 be able to access the service anymore.
9294
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009295 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9296 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009297
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009298 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9299 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9300 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9301 following order:
9302
9303 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9304
9305 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9306 list, or
9307
9308 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9309
9310 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9311 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9312
9313 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9314 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9315 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9316 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9317
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009318 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009319 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9320 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009322 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9323 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9324
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009325 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009326
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009327
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009328option redis-check
9329 Use redis health checks for server testing
9330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9331 yes | no | yes | yes
9332 Arguments : none
9333
9334 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9335 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9336 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9337 find the "+PONG" response message.
9338
9339 Example :
9340 option redis-check
9341
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009342 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009343
9344
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009345option smtpchk
9346option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9347 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9349 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009350 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009351 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009352 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009353 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9354
9355 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9356 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9357 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9358
9359 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9360 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9361 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9362 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9363 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9364 dead server.
9365
9366 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9367 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009369 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9370
9371 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9372 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9373 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9374 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009375 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009376
9377 Example :
9378 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9379
9380 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009383option socket-stats
9384no option socket-stats
9385
9386 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 yes | yes | yes | no
9389
9390 Arguments : none
9391
9392
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009393option splice-auto
9394no option splice-auto
9395 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9397 yes | yes | yes | yes
9398 Arguments : none
9399
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009400 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009401 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009402 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009403 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009404 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009405 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9406 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9407 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9408 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9409
9410 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9411 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9412 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9413 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9414 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9415 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9416 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9417 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9418 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9419 keyword.
9420
9421 Example :
9422 option splice-auto
9423
9424 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9425 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9426
9427 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9428 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9429
9430
9431option splice-request
9432no option splice-request
9433 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 yes | yes | yes | yes
9436 Arguments : none
9437
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009438 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009439 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009440 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9441 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9442 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9443 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9444
9445 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9446
9447 Example :
9448 option splice-request
9449
9450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9452
9453 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9454 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9455
9456
9457option splice-response
9458no option splice-response
9459 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9461 yes | yes | yes | yes
9462 Arguments : none
9463
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009464 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009465 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009466 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9467 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9468 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9469 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9470
9471 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9472
9473 Example :
9474 option splice-response
9475
9476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9478
9479 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9480 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9481
9482
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009483option spop-check
9484 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9486 no | no | no | yes
9487 Arguments : none
9488
9489 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9490 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9491 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9492 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9493
9494 Example :
9495 option spop-check
9496
9497 See also : "option httpchk"
9498
9499
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009500option srvtcpka
9501no option srvtcpka
9502 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9504 yes | no | yes | yes
9505 Arguments : none
9506
9507 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9508 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009509 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009510 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9511
9512 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9513 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9514 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9515 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9516
9517 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9518 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9519 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9520 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9521 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9522
9523 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9524
9525 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9526 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9527 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9528
9529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9531
9532 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9533
9534
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009535option ssl-hello-chk
9536 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9538 yes | no | yes | yes
9539 Arguments : none
9540
9541 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9542 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9543 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9544 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9545 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9546 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9547 hello message.
9548
9549 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9550 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9551 messages, which is appreciable.
9552
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009553 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009554 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9555 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009556
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009557 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9558
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009559
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009560option tcp-check
9561 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9562 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9563 yes | no | yes | yes
9564
9565 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9566 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9567
9568 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9569 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9570 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009572 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009573 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9574 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9575 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9576 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9577 only.
9578
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009579 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009580 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009581 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9582 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9583 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9584
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009585 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009586 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9587 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009588 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009589 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9590 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9591 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9592 the respective protocols.
9593 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009595
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009596 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009598 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9599 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9600 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9601 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009602
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009603 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9604 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9605 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009606
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009607
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009608 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009609 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009610 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009611 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009612
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009613 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009614 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009615 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009616
9617 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9618 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009619 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009621 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009623 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009624 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009625 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9626 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009627 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9629 tcp-check expect string +OK
9630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009632 (send many headers before analyzing)
9633 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009634 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009635 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9636 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9637 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9638 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009639 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009640
9641
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009642 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009643
9644
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009645option tcp-smart-accept
9646no option tcp-smart-accept
9647 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | yes | yes | no
9650 Arguments : none
9651
9652 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9653 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9654 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9655 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9656 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9657 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9658
9659 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9660 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9661 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9662 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9663
9664 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9665 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9666 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009667 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009668
9669 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9670 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9671 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9672
9673 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9674 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9675 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9676
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009677 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9678
9679
9680option tcp-smart-connect
9681no option tcp-smart-connect
9682 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | no | yes | yes
9685 Arguments : none
9686
9687 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9688 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9689 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9690 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9691 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9692
9693 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9694 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9695 complex.
9696
9697 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9698 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9699 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9700
9701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9703
9704 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9705
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009706
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009707option tcpka
9708 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9710 yes | yes | yes | yes
9711 Arguments : none
9712
9713 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9714 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009715 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009716 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9717
9718 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9719 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9720 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9721 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9722
9723 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9724 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9725 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9726 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9727 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9728
9729 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9730
9731 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9732 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9733 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9734 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9735 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9736 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9737 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9738 backends.
9739
9740 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9741
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009742
9743option tcplog
9744 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009746 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009747 Arguments : none
9748
9749 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9750 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9751 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9752 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9753 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9754 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9755 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9756 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9757
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009758 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009760 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009761
9762
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009763option transparent
9764no option transparent
9765 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009767 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009768 Arguments : none
9769
9770 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9771 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9772 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9773 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9774 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9775 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9776 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9777 appropriate server.
9778
9779 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9780 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9781
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009782 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009783 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009784
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009785
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009786external-check command <command>
9787 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9789 yes | no | yes | yes
9790
9791 Arguments :
9792 <command> is the external command to run
9793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009794 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9795
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009796 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009797
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009798 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9799 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9800 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9801 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9802 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9803 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009804
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009805 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9806
9807 Environment variables :
9808 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9809 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9810
9811 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9812
9813 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9814
9815 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9816 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9817 for a UNIX socket).
9818
9819 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9820
9821 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9822
9823 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9824
9825 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9826
9827 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9828
9829 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9830 socket).
9831
9832 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9833 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9834
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009835 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009837 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9838 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9839 failed.
9840
9841 Example :
9842 external-check command /bin/true
9843
9844 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9845
9846
9847external-check path <path>
9848 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9850 yes | no | yes | yes
9851
9852 Arguments :
9853 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9854
9855 The default path is "".
9856
9857 Example :
9858 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9859
9860 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9861 "external-check command"
9862
9863
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009864persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009865persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009866 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 yes | no | yes | yes
9869 Arguments :
9870 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009871 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9872 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009873
9874 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9875 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009876 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009877 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9878 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9879 forwarded to this server.
9880
9881 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9882 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9883 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009884 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009885 a single "listen" section.
9886
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009887 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9888 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9889 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9890
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009891 Example :
9892 listen tse-farm
9893 bind :3389
9894 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9895 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9896 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9897 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9898 persist rdp-cookie
9899 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009900 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009901 balance rdp-cookie
9902 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9903 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9904
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009905 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9906 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009907
9908
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009909rate-limit sessions <rate>
9910 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9912 yes | yes | yes | no
9913 Arguments :
9914 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9915 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9916
9917 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9918 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9919 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009920 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009921 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9922 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9923
9924 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9925 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9926 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9927 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9928
9929 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9930 listen smtp
9931 mode tcp
9932 bind :25
9933 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009934 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009935
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009936 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9937 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9938 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009939
9940 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9941
9942
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009943redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9944redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9945redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009946 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9948 no | yes | yes | yes
9949
9950 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009951 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009952
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009954 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009955 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9956 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9957 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009958
9959 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9960 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9961 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9962 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9963 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009964 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9965 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9966 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9967 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009968
9969 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9970 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9971 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9972 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9973 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9974 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009975 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009976 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009977 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9978 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9979 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009980
9981 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009982 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9983 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9984 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009985 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009986 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9987 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9988 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9989 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009990
9991 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009992 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009993
9994 - "drop-query"
9995 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9996 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9997 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9998 with a location-type redirect.
9999
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010000 - "append-slash"
10001 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10002 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10003 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10004 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10005
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010006 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10007 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10008 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10009 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10010 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10011 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10012 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10013
10014 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10015 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10016 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10017 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10018 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10019 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10020 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010021
10022 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10023 acl clear dst_port 80
10024 acl secure dst_port 8080
10025 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010026 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010027 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010028 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10029
10030 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010031 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10032 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10033 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010034 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010035
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010036 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10037 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10038 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10039
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010040 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010041 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010042
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010043 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010044 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10045 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10046 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010048 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010049
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010050
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010051retries <value>
10052 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10054 yes | no | yes | yes
10055 Arguments :
10056 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10057 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10058 default value is 3.
10059
10060 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10061 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10062 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10063
10064 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010065 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10066 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010067
10068 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10069 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10070
10071 See also : "option redispatch"
10072
10073
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010074retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010075 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10076 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10077 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10079 yes | no | yes | yes
10080 Arguments :
10081 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10082 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10083 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10084 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10085
10086 none never retry
10087
10088 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10089 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10090
10091 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10092 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10093 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10094 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10095 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10096 processing the request.
10097
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010098 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10099 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10100 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10101 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10102 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10103 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10104 overflow attack for example).
10105
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010106 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10107 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10108 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10109 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10110 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10111 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10112 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10113 amplify denial of service attacks.
10114
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010115 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10116 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10117 considered to be safe to retry.
10118
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010119 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10120 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10121 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10122 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10123 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010124
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010125 all-retryable-errors
10126 retry request for any error that are considered
10127 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10128 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10129 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10130
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010131 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10132 not cumulative.
10133
10134 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10135 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10136 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10137 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10138
10139 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10140 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10141 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10142 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10143 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10144 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10145 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10146 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10147 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10148 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10149 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10150 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10151
10152 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10153 should not use this directive.
10154
10155 The default is "conn-failure".
10156
10157 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10158
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010159server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010160 Declare a server in a backend
10161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10162 no | no | yes | yes
10163 Arguments :
10164 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010165 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010166 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010167
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010168 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10169 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10170 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10171 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010172 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10173 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010174 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010175 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10176 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010177 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10178 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10179 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10180 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10181 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10182 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10183 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010184 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010185 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10186 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10187 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10188 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10189 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10190 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010191 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10192 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010193 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10194 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010195
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010196 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010197 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10198 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10199 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10200 adding this value to the client's port.
10201
10202 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10203 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010204 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010205
10206 Examples :
10207 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10208 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010209 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010210 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10211 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10212 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010213
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010214 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10215 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10216 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10217 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10218 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10219
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010220 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10221 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010222
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010223server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010224 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010225 this backend.
10226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 no | no | yes | yes
10228
10229 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10230 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10231 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10232 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10233 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010234
10235 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10236 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10237
10238 global
10239 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10240
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010241 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010242 load-server-state-from-file
10243
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010244 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010245 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010246
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010247server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10248 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10249 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 no | no | yes | yes
10252
10253 Arguments:
10254 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10255
10256 <num | range>
10257 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10258 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10259 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10260 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10261
10262 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10263
10264 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10265
10266 <params*>
10267 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10268 keyword.
10269
10270 Examples:
10271 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10272 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10273 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10274
10275 # or
10276 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10277
10278 # would be equivalent to:
10279 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10280 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10281 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10282
10283
10284
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010285source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010286source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010287source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010288 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10290 yes | no | yes | yes
10291 Arguments :
10292 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10293 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010294
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010295 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010296 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10297 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10298 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10299 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10300 supported prefixes are :
10301 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10302 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10303 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010304 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010305 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10306 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010307
10308 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10309 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010310 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10311 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10312 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010313
10314 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10315 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10316 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10317 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10318 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10319 <addr>.
10320
10321 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10322 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10323 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10324 port.
10325
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010326 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10327 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10328 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10329 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010330 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010331 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10332 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10333 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10334 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10335 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10336 HTTP header.
10337
10338 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10339 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010340 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010341 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10342 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10343 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10344 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10345 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10346 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10347 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10348
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010349 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10350 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10351 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10352 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10353 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10354 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10355
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10357 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10358 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10359 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10360
10361 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10362 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10363 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10364 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10365 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10366 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10367
10368 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10369 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10370 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10371 there are two methods :
10372
10373 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10374 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10375 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10376 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10377 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10378 of the client ranges may be used.
10379
10380 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10381 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10382 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10383 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10384 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10385 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10386 same session.
10387
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010388 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10389 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10390 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010391 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010392
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010393 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10394
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010395 Examples :
10396 backend private
10397 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10398 source 192.168.1.200
10399
10400 backend transparent_ssl1
10401 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10402 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10403
10404 backend transparent_ssl2
10405 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10406 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10407 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10408
10409 backend transparent_ssl3
10410 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10411 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10412 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10413
10414 backend transparent_smtp
10415 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10416 # with Tproxy version 4.
10417 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10418
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010419 backend transparent_http
10420 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10421 # proxy.
10422 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010424 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010425 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10426
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010427
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010428srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10429 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10430 the connection on the server side.
10431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10432 yes | no | yes | yes
10433 Arguments :
10434 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10435
10436 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10437 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010438 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10439 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010440
10441 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10442
10443
10444srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10445 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10446 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10447 server side.
10448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10449 yes | no | yes | yes
10450 Arguments :
10451 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10452 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10453 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10454 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10455
10456 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10457 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010458 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10459 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010460
10461 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10462
10463
10464srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10465 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10467 yes | no | yes | yes
10468 Arguments :
10469 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10470 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10471 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10472 document.
10473
10474 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10475 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010476 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10477 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010478
10479 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10480
10481
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010482stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10483 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010485 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010486
10487 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10488 matched.
10489
10490 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10491 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10492
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010493 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10494 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10495 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10496 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010497
10498 Example :
10499 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10500 backend stats_localhost
10501 stats enable
10502 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10503
10504 Example :
10505 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10506 backend stats_auth
10507 stats enable
10508 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10509 stats admin if TRUE
10510
10511 Example :
10512 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10513 userlist stats-auth
10514 group admin users admin
10515 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10516 group readonly users haproxy
10517 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10518
10519 backend stats_auth
10520 stats enable
10521 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10522 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10523 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10524 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10525
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010526 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10527 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010528
10529
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10531 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010533 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010534 Arguments :
10535 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10536
10537 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10538
10539 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10540 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10541 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10542 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10543 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10544 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10545
10546 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10547 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10548 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010549 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010550
10551 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10552 report using "stats scope".
10553
10554 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10555 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10556 unobvious parameters.
10557
10558 Example :
10559 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10560 backend public_www
10561 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10562 stats enable
10563 stats hide-version
10564 stats scope .
10565 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010566 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010567 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10568 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10569
10570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10571 backend private_monitoring
10572 stats enable
10573 stats uri /admin?stats
10574 stats refresh 5s
10575
10576 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10577
10578
10579stats enable
10580 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010582 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010583 Arguments : none
10584
10585 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10586 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10587 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10588 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10589 - stats auth : no authentication
10590 - stats scope : no restriction
10591
10592 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10593 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10594 unobvious parameters.
10595
10596 Example :
10597 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10598 backend public_www
10599 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10600 stats enable
10601 stats hide-version
10602 stats scope .
10603 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010604 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010605 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10606 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10607
10608 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10609 backend private_monitoring
10610 stats enable
10611 stats uri /admin?stats
10612 stats refresh 5s
10613
10614 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10615
10616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010617stats hide-version
10618 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010621 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010623 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10624 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10625 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10626 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10627 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10628 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010630 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10631 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10632 unobvious parameters.
10633
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010634 Example :
10635 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10636 backend public_www
10637 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010638 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010639 stats hide-version
10640 stats scope .
10641 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010642 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010643 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10644 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010645
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010646 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10647 backend private_monitoring
10648 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010649 stats uri /admin?stats
10650 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010651
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010652 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010653
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010654
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010655stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10657 Access control for statistics
10658
10659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10660 no | no | yes | yes
10661
10662 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10663 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10664 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10665 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10666 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10667 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10668
10669 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10670 instance.
10671
10672 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10673 about ACL usage.
10674
10675
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010676stats realm <realm>
10677 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010679 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010680 Arguments :
10681 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10682 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10683 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10684
10685 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10686 using a backslash ('\').
10687
10688 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10689 only related to authentication.
10690
10691 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10692 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10693 unobvious parameters.
10694
10695 Example :
10696 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10697 backend public_www
10698 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10699 stats enable
10700 stats hide-version
10701 stats scope .
10702 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010703 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010704 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10705 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10706
10707 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10708 backend private_monitoring
10709 stats enable
10710 stats uri /admin?stats
10711 stats refresh 5s
10712
10713 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10714
10715
10716stats refresh <delay>
10717 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010719 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010720 Arguments :
10721 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10722 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10723 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10724 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10725 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10726 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10727
10728 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10729 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10730 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010731 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010732
10733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10735 unobvious parameters.
10736
10737 Example :
10738 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10739 backend public_www
10740 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10741 stats enable
10742 stats hide-version
10743 stats scope .
10744 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010745 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010746 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10747 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10748
10749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10750 backend private_monitoring
10751 stats enable
10752 stats uri /admin?stats
10753 stats refresh 5s
10754
10755 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10756
10757
10758stats scope { <name> | "." }
10759 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010761 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010762 Arguments :
10763 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10764 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10765 section in which the statement appears.
10766
10767 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10768 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10769 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10770 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10771 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10772 exists.
10773
10774 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10775 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10776 unobvious parameters.
10777
10778 Example :
10779 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10780 backend public_www
10781 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10782 stats enable
10783 stats hide-version
10784 stats scope .
10785 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010786 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010787 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10788 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10789
10790 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10791 backend private_monitoring
10792 stats enable
10793 stats uri /admin?stats
10794 stats refresh 5s
10795
10796 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10797
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010798
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010799stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010800 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010802 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010804 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010805 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10806
10807 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10808 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10809
10810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010812 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813
10814 Example :
10815 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10816 backend private_monitoring
10817 stats enable
10818 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10819 stats uri /admin?stats
10820 stats refresh 5s
10821
10822 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10823 global section.
10824
10825
10826stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010827 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10829 yes | yes | yes | yes
10830 Arguments : none
10831
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010832 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010833 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10834 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10835 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10836 - IP (socket, server)
10837 - cookie (backend, server)
10838
10839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010841 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010842
10843 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10844
10845
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010846stats show-modules
10847 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10849 yes | yes | yes | yes
10850 Arguments : none
10851
10852 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10853 values as a tooltip.
10854
10855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10857 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10858
10859 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10860
10861
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010862stats show-node [ <name> ]
10863 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010866 Arguments:
10867 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10868 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10869
10870 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10871 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010872 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010873
10874 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10875 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10876 unobvious parameters.
10877
10878 Example:
10879 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10880 backend private_monitoring
10881 stats enable
10882 stats show-node Europe-1
10883 stats uri /admin?stats
10884 stats refresh 5s
10885
10886 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10887 section.
10888
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889
10890stats uri <prefix>
10891 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010894 Arguments :
10895 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10896 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10897 query string.
10898
10899 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10900 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10901 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10902 possible to reach it in the application.
10903
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010904 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010905 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010906 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10907 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10908 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10909 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10910
10911 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10912 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10913 an address or a port to statistics only.
10914
10915 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10916 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10917 unobvious parameters.
10918
10919 Example :
10920 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10921 backend public_www
10922 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10923 stats enable
10924 stats hide-version
10925 stats scope .
10926 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10929 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10930
10931 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10932 backend private_monitoring
10933 stats enable
10934 stats uri /admin?stats
10935 stats refresh 5s
10936
10937 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10938
10939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010940stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10941 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010943 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010944
10945 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010946 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010947 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010949 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10950
10951 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10952 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10953 the "stick-table" statement.
10954
10955 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10956 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10957 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10958 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10959 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10960
10961 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10962 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10963 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10964 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10965 transformation rules.
10966
10967 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10968 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10969 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10970 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10971 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10972 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10973 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10974
10975 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10976 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10977 ACL based conditions.
10978
10979 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10980 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10981 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10982 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10983
10984 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10985 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10986 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10987 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10988
10989 Example :
10990 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10991 # last 30 minutes
10992 backend pop
10993 mode tcp
10994 balance roundrobin
10995 stick store-request src
10996 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10997 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10998 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10999
11000 backend smtp
11001 mode tcp
11002 balance roundrobin
11003 stick match src table pop
11004 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11005 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11006
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011007 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11008 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011009
11010
11011stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11012 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11014 no | no | yes | yes
11015
11016 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11017 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11018 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11019 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11020
11021 Examples :
11022 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011023 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011024
11025 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11026 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11027 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11028
11029
11030 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11031 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11032 backend http
11033 mode http
11034 balance roundrobin
11035 stick on src table https
11036 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11037 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11038 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11039
11040 backend https
11041 mode tcp
11042 balance roundrobin
11043 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11044 stick on src
11045 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11046 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11047
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011048 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011049
11050
11051stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11052 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11054 no | no | yes | yes
11055
11056 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011057 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011058 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011059 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011060 server is selected.
11061
11062 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11063 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11064 the "stick-table" statement.
11065
11066 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11067 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11068 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11069 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11070 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11071 address.
11072
11073 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11074 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11075 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11076 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11077 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11078 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11079 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11080 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11081 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11082 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11083
11084 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11085 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11086 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11087 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11088 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11089 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11090 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11091
11092 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11093 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11094 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11095 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11096
11097 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11098 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11099 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11100 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11101 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11102 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011103 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11104 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11105 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11106 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11107 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11108 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011109
11110 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11111 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11112 the request.
11113
11114 Example :
11115 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11116 # last 30 minutes
11117 backend pop
11118 mode tcp
11119 balance roundrobin
11120 stick store-request src
11121 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11122 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11123 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11124
11125 backend smtp
11126 mode tcp
11127 balance roundrobin
11128 stick match src table pop
11129 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11130 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11131
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011132 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011133
11134
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011135stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011136 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011137 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011138 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011140 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011141
11142 Arguments :
11143 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11144 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11145 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11146 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11147
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011148 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11149 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11150 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11151 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11152
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011153 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11154 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11155 instance.
11156
11157 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11158 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11159 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11160 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11161 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11162 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011163 to 32 characters.
11164
11165 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11166 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11167 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011168 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011169 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11170 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011171
11172 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011173 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11174 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011175 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11176 increase.
11177
11178 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011179 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11180 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11181 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011182
11183 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011184 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011185 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11186 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011187 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011188 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11189 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11190 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11191 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11192 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11193 parameter (see below).
11194
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011195 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11196 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11197 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11198 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11199 soft restart.
11200
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011201 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11202 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11203 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11204 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011205 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011206 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11208 if not expiration delay is specified.
11209
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011210 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11211 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11212 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11213 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11214 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11215 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11216 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11217 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11218 token.
11219
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011220 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11221 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11222 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11223 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011224 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11225 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11226 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11227 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11228 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11229 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11230 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11231 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11232 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11233 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11234 types and their arguments.
11235
11236 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11237 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11238 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11239 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11240
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011241 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11242 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11243 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11244 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11245 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11246 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11247 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11248 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11249 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11250 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011251 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11252 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11253 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11254 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011255
11256 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11257 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11258 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11259 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11260 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11261 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11262 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11263 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11264 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11265 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11266 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11267 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011268 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11269 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11270 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11271 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011272
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011273 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11274 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11275 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011276 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011277
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011278 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11279 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11280 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011281 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011282 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011283 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011284
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011285 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11286 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11287 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11288 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11289
11290 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11291 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11292 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11293 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11294 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11295 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11296
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011297 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11298 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11299 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11300 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11301 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11302 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11303 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11304 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11305 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11306 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011307 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11308 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11309 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011310
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011311 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11312 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11313 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11314 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011316 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11317 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11318 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11319 they were received.
11320
11321 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11322 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11323 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11324 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11325 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11326
11327 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11328 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11329 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11330 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11331 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11332
11333 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11334 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11335 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11336
11337 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11338 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11339 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11340 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11341 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11342
11343 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11344 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11345 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11346 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11347 the client side.
11348
11349 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11350 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11351 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11352 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11353 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11354 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11355 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11356
11357 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11358 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11359 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11360 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11361 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11362 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011363 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011364
11365 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11366 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11367 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11368 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11369 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11370 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11371
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011372 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11373 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11374 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11375 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11376 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11377
11378 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11379 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11380 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11381 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11382 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11383 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11384
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011385 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011386 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011387 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11388 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11389
11390 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11391 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11392 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11393 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11394 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11395 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11396 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11397 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11398 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11399 recommended for better fairness.
11400
11401 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011403 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11404 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11405
11406 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11407 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11408 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11409 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11410 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11411 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11412 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11413 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11414 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11415 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011416
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011417 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11418 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011419 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11420 reference it.
11421
11422 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11423 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011424 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11425 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11426 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011427
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11429 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11430 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11431 something that can be ignored.
11432
11433 Example:
11434 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11435 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11436 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11437 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11438
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011439 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011440 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011441
11442
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011443stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011444 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11446 no | no | yes | yes
11447
11448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011449 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011450 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011451 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011452 server is selected.
11453
11454 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11455 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11456 the "stick-table" statement.
11457
11458 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11459 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11460 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11461 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11462
11463 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11464 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11465 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11466 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11467 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11468 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011469 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011470 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11471 rules.
11472
11473 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11474 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11475 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11476 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11477 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11478 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11479 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11480
11481 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11482 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11483 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11484 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11485
11486 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11487 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11488 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11489 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11490 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11491 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011492 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11493 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11494 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11495 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11496 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11497 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11498 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11499 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11500 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011501
11502 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11503
11504 Example :
11505 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11506 backend https
11507 mode tcp
11508 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011509 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011510 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011511
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011512 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11513 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11514
11515 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11516 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11517 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11518
11519 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11520 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011521
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011522 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11523 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11524 # at offset 44.
11525
11526 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11527 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11528
11529 # Learn on response if server hello.
11530 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011531
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011532 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11533 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11534
11535 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11536 extraction.
11537
11538
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011539tcp-check comment <string>
11540 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11541 it fails.
11542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11543 yes | no | yes | yes
11544
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011545 Arguments :
11546 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11547 rule fails.
11548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011549 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11550 user-friendly error reporting.
11551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011552 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11553 "tcp-check expect".
11554
11555
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011556tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11557 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011558 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011559 Opens a new connection
11560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011561 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011562
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011563 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011564 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11565
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011566 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011567 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011568
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011569 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011570 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11571 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011572 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011573
11574 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011575
11576 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11577
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011578 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11579
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011580 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11581
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011582 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11583
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011584 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11585 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11586 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11587 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11588
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011589 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11590 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11591 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11592 haproxy -vv.
11593
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011594 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011595
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011596 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11597 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11598 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11599
11600 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11601 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11602 of the sequence.
11603
11604 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11605 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11606 do.
11607
11608 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11609 unset-var or comment rules.
11610
11611 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011612 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11613 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11614 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11615 option tcp-check
11616 tcp-check connect
11617 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11618 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11619 tcp-check send \r\n
11620 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11621 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11622 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11623 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11624 tcp-check send \r\n
11625 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11626 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11627
11628 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11629 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011630 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011631 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11632 tcp-check connect port 143
11633 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11634 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11635
11636 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11637
11638
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011639tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011640 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011641 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011642 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011643 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011645 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011646
11647 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011648 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11649
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011650 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11651 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11652 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11653 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11654 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11655 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11656 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11657 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11658 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11659 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11660
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011661 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011662 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11663 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011664 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11665 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11666 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11667
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011668 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11669 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11670 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011671 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11672 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011673 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11674 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011675 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11676 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011677 By default "L7OK" is used.
11678
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011679 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11680 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011681 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11682 supported :
11683 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11684 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011685 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11686 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11687 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11688 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11689 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011690
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011691 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011692 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011693 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11694 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11695 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11696 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011697 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11698
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011699 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11700 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11701 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11702 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11703
11704 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11705 informational message reported in logs if an error
11706 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11707 log-format string.
11708
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011709 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11710 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11711 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11712 followed by some converters.
11713
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11715 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11716 with the usual backslash ('\').
11717 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011718 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011719 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11720 used upper or lower case.
11721
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011722 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11723
11724 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11725 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11726 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11727 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11728 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11729 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11730 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11731 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11732
11733 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11734 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11735 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11736 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11737 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11738 expression.
11739
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011740 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11741 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11742 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11743 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11744 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11745 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11746
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011747 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11748 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11749 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11750 this exact hexadecimal string.
11751 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11752
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011753 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11754 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11755 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11756 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11757 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11758 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11759 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11760 size.
11761
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011762 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11763 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11764 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11765 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11766 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11767 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11768 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11769 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11770 in a binary string before matching the response's
11771 buffer.
11772
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011773 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011774 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011775 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11776 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11777 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11778 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11779 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11780 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11781 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11782 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11783 the null character.
11784
11785 Examples :
11786 # perform a POP check
11787 option tcp-check
11788 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11789
11790 # perform an IMAP check
11791 option tcp-check
11792 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11793
11794 # look for the redis master server
11795 option tcp-check
11796 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011797 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011798 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11799 tcp-check expect string role:master
11800 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11801 tcp-check expect string +OK
11802
11803
11804 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011805 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011806
11807
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011808tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11809tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11810 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11811 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011813 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011814
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011815 Arguments :
11816 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11817
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011818 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11819 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011820
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011821 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11822 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011823
11824 Examples :
11825 # look for the redis master server
11826 option tcp-check
11827 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11828 tcp-check expect string role:master
11829
11830 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011831 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011832
11833
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011834tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11835tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11836 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11837 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011839 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011840
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011841 Arguments :
11842 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011843
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011844 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11845 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011846
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011847 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11848 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11849 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011850
11851 Examples :
11852 # redis check in binary
11853 option tcp-check
11854 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11855 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11856
11857
11858 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011859 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011860
11861
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011862tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011863 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011865 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011866
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011867 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011868 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11869 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11870 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11871 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11872 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11874 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11875 and '-'.
11876
11877 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11878
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011879 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011880 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11881
11882
11883tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011884 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011886 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011887
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011888 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011889 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11890 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11891 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11892 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11893 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11894 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11895 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11896 and '-'.
11897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011898 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011899 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11900
11901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011902tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11903 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11905 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011906 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011907 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11908 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011910 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011911
11912 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11913 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011914 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11915 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11916 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11917 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11918 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11919 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011921 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11922 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11923 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11924 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011925
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011926 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011927 - accept :
11928 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11929 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11930 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011932 - reject :
11933 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11934 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11935 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11936 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11937 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11938 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11939 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11940 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11941 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11942 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11943 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011944 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011945
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011946 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11947 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11948 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11949 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11950 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11951 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11952 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11953 hosts.
11954
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011955 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11956 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11957 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11958 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11959 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11960 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11961 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11962 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11963
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011964 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11965 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11966 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11967 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11968 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11969 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11970 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11971 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11972 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011973 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11974 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011975
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011976 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011977 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011978 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11979 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11980 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011981 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011982 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011983 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11984 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11985 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11986 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11987 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11988 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11989 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011991 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011992 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011994 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011995 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11996 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11997 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011999 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12000 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12001 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12002 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012004 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12005 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12006 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12007 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12008 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012009 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12010 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12011 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12012 layer7 information is extracted.
12013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012014 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12015 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12016 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12017 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12018 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012019
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012020 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12021 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12022 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12023 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12024 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12025 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12026 no GPC stored at this index.
12027 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12028 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12029 data_types).
12030
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012031 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12032 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12033 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12034 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12035
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012036 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12037 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12038 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12039 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12040
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012041 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12042 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12043 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12044 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12045 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12046 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12047 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12048 no GPT stored at this index.
12049 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12050 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12051
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012052 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12053 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12054 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12055 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12056 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012057
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012058 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012059 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12060 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12061 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12062 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12063 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12064 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12065 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12066 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012067 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012068
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012069 - set-src <expr> :
12070 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12071 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12072 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012073 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012075 Arguments:
12076 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12077 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012078
12079 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012080 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12081
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012082 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12083 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012084
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012085 - set-src-port <expr> :
12086 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12087 expression.
12088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012089 Arguments:
12090 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12091 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012092
12093 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012094 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12095
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012096 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12097 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12098 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012099
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012100 - set-dst <expr> :
12101 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12102 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12103 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12104 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12105 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12106
12107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12108 followed by some converters.
12109
12110 Example:
12111
12112 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12113 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12114
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012115 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12116 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12117
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012118 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12119 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12120 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12121 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12122
12123
12124 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12125 followed by some converters.
12126
12127 Example:
12128
12129 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12130
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012131 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12132 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12133 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12134
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012135 - set-tos <tos>:
12136 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12137 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12138 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12139 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12140 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12141 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12142 routers based on some information from the request.
12143
12144 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12145
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012146 - "silent-drop" :
12147 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012148 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012149 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12150 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12151 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12152 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12153 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012154 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12155 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012156 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12157 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012158 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012159 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12160 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12161 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12162 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012164 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12165 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12166 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012167
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012168 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12169 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12170 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012173 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012174 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012176 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12177 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12178 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012180 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012181 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12182 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012183
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012184 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12185
12186 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12187
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012188 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12189
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012190 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012191
12192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012193tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12194 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012196 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012198 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12199 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012201 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012203 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012204 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12205 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012206 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12207 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012209 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12210 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12211 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12212 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012213 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012214 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012215 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12216 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12217 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12218 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012219 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012220 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012222 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12223 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12224 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12225 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012226
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012227 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012228 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012229 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012230 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12231 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012232 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012233 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012234 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012235 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012236 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012237 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012238 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012239 - set-dst <expr>
12240 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012241 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012242 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012243 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012244 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012245 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012246 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012247 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012248 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012249 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012250 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012252 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12253 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012254 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12255 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012256
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012257 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12258 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12259 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12260 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12261 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12262 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012264 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12266 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012267
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012268 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12269 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12270 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12271 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12272 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12273 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012276 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12277 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12278 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12279 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12280 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12281 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12282 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12283 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12284 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12285 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012287 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012288 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12289 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12290 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012291
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012292 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12293 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12294
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012295 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12296 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12297
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012298 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12299 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12300
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012301 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12302 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12303
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012304 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12305 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12306
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012307 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012308 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12309 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012310
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012311 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12312 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012313 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012314 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12315 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012316 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012317 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012318 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012319 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12320 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012322 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12323 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012324
12325 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12326 followed by some converters.
12327
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012328 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012329 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12330 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12331 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12332 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12333 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12334 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012335 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012336 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12337 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12338
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012339 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12340
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012341 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12342 <var-name>.
12343
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012344 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12345 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12346 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12347 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12348 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12349
12350 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12351 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12352 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12353 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12354 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12355 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12356 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12357 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12358 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12359 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12360 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12361
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012362 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12363 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12364 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12365 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12366 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12367
12368 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12369
12370 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12371
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012372 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12373 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12374 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12375 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12376 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12377 evaluated.
12378
12379 Example:
12380 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12381
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012382 Example:
12383
12384 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012385 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012386
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012387 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012388 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012389 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012390 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12391 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012392 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012393 tcp-request content reject
12394
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012395 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12396 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12397 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12398 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12399 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12400 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12401 ...
12402 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12403
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012404 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012405 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12406 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12407 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012408 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012409
12410 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12411 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12412 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012413 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012414 tcp-request content reject
12415
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012416 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012417 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012418 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012419 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012420 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12421 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012422
12423 Example:
12424 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12425 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012426 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012428 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012429 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012430
12431 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012432 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012433 # protecting all our sites
12434 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012435 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12436 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012437 ...
12438 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12439
12440 backend http_dynamic
12441 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012442 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012443 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012444 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012445 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012446 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012447 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012449 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012450
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012451 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12452 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012453
12454
12455tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12456 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012458 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012459 Arguments :
12460 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12461 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12462 as explained at the top of this document.
12463
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012464 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012465 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12466 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12467 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12468 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12469
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012470 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12471 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12472 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12473 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12474
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012475 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012476 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012477 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012478 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012479 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012480 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12481 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12482 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012483
12484 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12485 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12486 it pass through unaffected.
12487
12488 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12489 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12490 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012491 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012492 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12493 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012494 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12495 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12496 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012497
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012498 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499 "timeout client".
12500
12501
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012502tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12503 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12505 no | no | yes | yes
12506 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012507 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12508 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012509
12510 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012512 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012513 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12514 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012515 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12516 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012517
12518 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12519
12520 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12521 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12522 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12523 inserted.
12524
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012525 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012526 - accept :
12527 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12528 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12529 the rules evaluation.
12530
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012531 - close :
12532 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12533 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12534 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12535 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12536 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12537 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012538 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012539 protocols.
12540
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012541 - reject :
12542 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12543 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012544 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012545
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012546 - set-log-level <level>
12547 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12548 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12549 set-log-level".
12550
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012551 - set-mark <mark>
12552 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12553 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12554 set-mark".
12555
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012556 - set-nice <nice>
12557 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12558 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12559 set-nice".
12560
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012561 - set-tos <tos>
12562 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12563 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12564 set-tos".
12565
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012566 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12567 Sets a variable.
12568
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012569 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12570 Unsets a variable.
12571
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012572 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12573 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12574 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12575 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12576 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12577 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12578 no GPC stored at this index.
12579 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12580 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12581 data_types).
12582
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012583 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12584 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12585 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12586 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12587
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012588 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12589 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12590 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12591 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12592
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012593 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12594 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12595 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12596 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12597 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12598 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12599 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12600 no GPT stored at this index.
12601 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12602 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12603
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012604 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12605 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12606 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12607 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12608 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012609
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012610 - "silent-drop" :
12611 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012612 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012613 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12614 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12615 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12616 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12617 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012618 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12619 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012620 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12621 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012622 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012623 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12624 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12625 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12626 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12627
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012628 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12629 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12630
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012631 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12632 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12633 for changing the default action to a reject.
12634
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012635 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12636 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12637 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12638 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012639 period.
12640
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012641 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12642 declared inline.
12643
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012644 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12645 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012646 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012647 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12648 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012649 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012650 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012651 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12653 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012655 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12656 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012657
12658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12659 followed by some converters.
12660
12661 Example:
12662
12663 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12664
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012665 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12666 <var-name>.
12667
12668 Example:
12669
12670 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12671
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012672 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12673 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12674 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12675 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12676 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12677
12678 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12679
12680 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12681
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012682 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12683
12684 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12685
12686
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012687tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12688 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12690 no | yes | yes | no
12691 Arguments :
12692 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12693 below.
12694
12695 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012697 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012698 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12699 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12700 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12701 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12702 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12703 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12704 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012705 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012706 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12707 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12708 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12709 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12710 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12711 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12712 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12713 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12714 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12715 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12716 instead.
12717
12718 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12719 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12720 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12721 rules which may be inserted.
12722
12723 Several types of actions are supported :
12724 - accept : the request is accepted
12725 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12726 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012727 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012728 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012729 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012730 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012731 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012732 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012733 - set-dst <expr>
12734 - set-dst-port <expr>
12735 - set-src <expr>
12736 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012737 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012738 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012739 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012740 - silent-drop
12741
12742 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12743 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12744 sections for a complete description.
12745
12746 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12747 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12748 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12749
12750 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12751 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12752 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12753 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12754 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12755
12756 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12757 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12758
12759 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12760 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12761 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12762
12763 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12764 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12766
12767 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12768 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12769 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12770
12771 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12772 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12773 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12774
12775 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12776
12777 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12778
12779
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012780tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12781 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12783 no | no | yes | yes
12784 Arguments :
12785 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12786 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12787 as explained at the top of this document.
12788
12789 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12790
12791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012792timeout check <timeout>
12793 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12794 established.
12795
12796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12797 yes | no | yes | yes
12798 Arguments:
12799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12801 as explained at the top of this document.
12802
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012803 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012804 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012805 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012806 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012807 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12808 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12809 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012811 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012812 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12813
12814 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12815 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012816 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012817
12818 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12819 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12820 forget about it.
12821
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012822 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12823 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012824
12825
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012826timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12829 yes | yes | yes | no
12830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12833 as explained at the top of this document.
12834
12835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12837 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012838 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12839 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12840 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12841 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012842 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12843 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12844 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012845 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012846 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012847 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12848 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012849 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12850 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012851
12852 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12853 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12854 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12855 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012856 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012857 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12858
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012859 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012860
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012861 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012863
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012864timeout client-fin <timeout>
12865 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12867 yes | yes | yes | no
12868 Arguments :
12869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12871 as explained at the top of this document.
12872
12873 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12874 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12875 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12876 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12877 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12878 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12879 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012880 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12881 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12882 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012883
12884 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12885 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12886 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12887
12888 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12889
12890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012891timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012892 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12894 yes | no | yes | yes
12895 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012896 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012897 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12898 as explained at the top of this document.
12899
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012900 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012901 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012902 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012903 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012904 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12905 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012906
12907 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12908 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12909 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12910 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012911 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012912 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12913
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012914 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012915
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012916
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012917timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12918 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12920 yes | yes | yes | yes
12921 Arguments :
12922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12924 as explained at the top of this document.
12925
12926 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12927 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12928 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12929 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12930 once the request has started to present itself.
12931
12932 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12933 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12934 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12935 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12936 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12937
12938 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12939 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12940 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12941 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12942
12943 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12944 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012945 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012946 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12947 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012948 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012949
12950 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12951 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12952 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12953 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12954
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012955 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12956 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012957 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12958
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012959 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12960
12961
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012962timeout http-request <timeout>
12963 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012965 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012966 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012967 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012968 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12969 as explained at the top of this document.
12970
12971 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12972 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12973 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12974 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12975 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12976 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12977 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012978 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12979 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12980 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12981 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012982 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012983 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12984 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012985
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012986 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12987 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12988 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12989 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12990 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012991 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012992
12993 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12994 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012995 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012996 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12997 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12998
12999 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013000 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13001 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13002 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013003
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013004 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013005 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013006
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013007
13008timeout queue <timeout>
13009 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13011 yes | no | yes | yes
13012 Arguments :
13013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13015 as explained at the top of this document.
13016
13017 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13018 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13019 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13020 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13021 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13022
13023 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13024 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13025 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13026 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13027
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013028 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013029
13030
13031timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013032 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13034 yes | no | yes | yes
13035 Arguments :
13036 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13037 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13038 as explained at the top of this document.
13039
13040 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13041 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13042 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13043 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13044 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13045 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13046 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13047
13048 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13049 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13050 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13051 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13052 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013053 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013054 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013055 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13056 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013057 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13058 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013059
13060 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13061 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13062 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13063 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013064 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013065 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13066
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013067 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013068
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013069
13070timeout server-fin <timeout>
13071 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13073 yes | no | yes | yes
13074 Arguments :
13075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13077 as explained at the top of this document.
13078
13079 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13080 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13081 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13082 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13083 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13084 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13085 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13086 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13087 situations, it should not be needed.
13088
13089 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13090 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13091 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13092
13093 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13094
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013095
13096timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013097 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13099 yes | yes | yes | yes
13100 Arguments :
13101 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13102 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13103 as explained at the top of this document.
13104
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013105 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13106 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13107 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013108
13109 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13110 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13111 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13112 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013113 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013114
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013115 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013116
13117
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013118timeout tunnel <timeout>
13119 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13121 yes | no | yes | yes
13122 Arguments :
13123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13125 as explained at the top of this document.
13126
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013127 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013128 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13129 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13130 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13132 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013133 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13134 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13135 specified.
13136
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013137 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13138 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13139 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13140 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13141 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13142 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13143 state.
13144
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013145 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13146 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13147 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13148 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013149 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013150
13151 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13152 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13153 forget about it.
13154
13155 Example :
13156 defaults http
13157 option http-server-close
13158 timeout connect 5s
13159 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013160 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013161 timeout server 30s
13162 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13163
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013164 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013165
13166
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013167transparent (deprecated)
13168 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013170 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013171 Arguments : none
13172
13173 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13174 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13175 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13176 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13177 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13178 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13179 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13180 appropriate server.
13181
13182 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13183
13184 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13185 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13186
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013187 See also: "option transparent"
13188
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013189unique-id-format <string>
13190 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13192 yes | yes | yes | no
13193 Arguments :
13194 <string> is a log-format string.
13195
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013196 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13197 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13198 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13199 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013200
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013201 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013202 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013203 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13204 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13205 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13206 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13207 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13208 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013209
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013210 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13211 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013212
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013213 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013214
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013215 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013216
13217 will generate:
13218
13219 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13220
13221 See also: "unique-id-header"
13222
13223unique-id-header <name>
13224 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13226 yes | yes | yes | no
13227 Arguments :
13228 <name> is the name of the header.
13229
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013230 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13231 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013232
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013233 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013234
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013235 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013236 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13237
13238 will generate:
13239
13240 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13241
13242 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013243
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013244use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013245 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13247 no | yes | yes | no
13248 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013249 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13250 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013252 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13253 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013254
13255 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13256 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13257 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013258 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013259 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013260 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13261 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262
13263 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13264 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13265 assign the backend.
13266
13267 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13268 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13269 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13270 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13271 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13272 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13273
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013274 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013275 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013276 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13277 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13278 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13279
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013280 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13281 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13282 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13283 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13284 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13285 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13286 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13287 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13288 cannot be forced from the request.
13289
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013290 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013291 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13292 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13293
13294 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13295 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013296
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013297use-fcgi-app <name>
13298 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13300 no | no | yes | yes
13301 Arguments :
13302 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13303
13304 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013305
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013306use-server <server> if <condition>
13307use-server <server> unless <condition>
13308 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13310 no | no | yes | yes
13311 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013312 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13313 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013314
13315 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13316
13317 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13318 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13319 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13320
13321 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13322 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13323 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13324 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13325 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13326 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13327 matches will assign the server.
13328
13329 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13330 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13331 with the next rules until one matches.
13332
13333 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13334 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13335 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13336 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13337
13338 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13339 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13340 stripped.
13341
13342 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13343 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013344 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013345 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013346 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013347
13348 Example :
13349 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013350 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013351 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013352 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013353 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013354 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013355 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013356 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13357 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13358
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013359 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13360 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13361 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13362 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013363 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013364 and we fall back to load balancing.
13365
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013366 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013368
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133695. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013370--------------------------
13371
13372The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13373depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13374settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13375written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13376described in this section.
13377
13378
133795.1. Bind options
13380-----------------
13381
13382The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13383as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13384no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13385parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13386while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13387provided immediately after the setting name.
13388
13389The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13390
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013391accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13392 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13393 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13394 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13395 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13396 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13397 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13398 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13399 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13400 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013401 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13402 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13403 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013405accept-proxy
13406 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013407 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13408 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013409 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13410 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13411 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13412 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013414 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13415 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013416 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13417 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013418
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013419allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013420 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013421 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013422 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013423 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13424 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013425
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013426alpn <protocols>
13427 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13428 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13429 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013430 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013431 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013432 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13433 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13434 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13435 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13436 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13437 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13438 preference, like below :
13439
13440 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013442backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013443 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013444 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13445
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013446curves <curves>
13447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13448 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13449 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13450 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13451 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13452 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13453
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013454ecdhe <named curve>
13455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013456 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13457 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013458
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013459ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13461 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13462 client's certificate.
13463
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013464ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13466 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13467 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13468 error is ignored.
13469
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013470ca-sign-file <cafile>
13471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13472 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13473 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13474 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13475 'generate-certificates' for details.
13476
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013477ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13479 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13480 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13481 'generate-certificates' for details.
13482
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013483ca-verify-file <cafile>
13484 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13485 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13486 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13487 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13488 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13489
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013490ciphers <ciphers>
13491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13492 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013493 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013494 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013495 information and recommendations see e.g.
13496 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13497 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13498 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13499
13500ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13502 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13503 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13504 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013505 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13506 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013507
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013508crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13510 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013511 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13512 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013513
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013514crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13516 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13517 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13518 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13519 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013520 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13521 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013522
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013523 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13524 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13525
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013526 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13527 are loaded.
13528
13529 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013530 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13531 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13532 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13533 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13534 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13535 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13536 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013537 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013538
13539 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13540 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13541 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13542 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013543 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13544 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013545
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013546 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013548 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013549 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013550 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13551 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013552 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13553 clients).
13554
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013555 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013556 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13557 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13558 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13559 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13560 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13561 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13562 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13563 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13564 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13565 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13566 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13567 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013569 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013570 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13571 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13572 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13573 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13574
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013575 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13576 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13577 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13578 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013579
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013580 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13581 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13582 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013583
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013584crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013586 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013587 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013588 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013589
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013590crt-list <file>
13591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013592 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13593 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013594
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013595 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13596
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013597 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13598 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13599 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13600 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13601 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013602
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013603 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013604 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13605 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13606 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13607 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13608 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013609 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13610 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13611 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013612
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013613 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13614 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13615 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013616
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013617 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13618
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013619 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013620 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013621 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13622 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13623 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13624 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13625 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13626 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013627
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013628 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013629 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013630 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013631 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013632 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013633 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013634
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013635defer-accept
13636 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13637 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13638 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013639 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013640 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13641 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13642 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13643 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13644 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13645 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13646 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13647
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013648expose-fd listeners
13649 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13650 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013651 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13652 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013653 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013654
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013655force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013656 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013657 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013658 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013660
13661force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013663 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013665
13666force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013668 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013669 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013670
13671force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013673 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013675
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013676force-tlsv13
13677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013680
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013681generate-certificates
13682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13683 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13684 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13685 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13686 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13687 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13688 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13689 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13690 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13691 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13692 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13693
13694 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13695 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013696 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013697 certificate is used many times.
13698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013699gid <gid>
13700 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13701 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13702 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13703 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13704 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13705
13706group <group>
13707 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13708 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13709 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13710 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13711 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13712
13713id <id>
13714 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13715 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13716 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13717 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13718
13719interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013720 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13721 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13722 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13723 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13724 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13725 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013726 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13727 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13728 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13729 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13730 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13731 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013732
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013733level <level>
13734 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13735 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13736 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013738 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13739 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13740 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013741 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013742 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013743 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013744 all counters).
13745
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013746severity-output <format>
13747 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13748 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13749 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13750 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13751 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13752 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13753 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13754 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13755 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13756 rfc5424 convention.
13757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013758maxconn <maxconn>
13759 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13760 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13761 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13762 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13763 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13764 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13765 eat all memory.
13766
13767mode <mode>
13768 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13769 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13770 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13771 UNIX sockets.
13772
13773mss <maxseg>
13774 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13775 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13776 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13777 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13778 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13779 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13780 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13781 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13782 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13783 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13784 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13785
13786name <name>
13787 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13788 page.
13789
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013790namespace <name>
13791 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13792 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13793 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13794 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13795
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013796nice <nice>
13797 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13798 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13799 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13800 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13801 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13802 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13803 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13804 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13805 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13806 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13807 one for an RDP socket.
13808
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013809no-ca-names
13810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13811 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013812 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013813
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013814no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013816 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013817 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013818 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013819 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13820 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013821
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013822no-tls-tickets
13823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13824 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13825 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013826 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13827 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013828 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13829 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13830 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013831
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013832no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013834 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013835 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013836 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013837 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13838 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013839
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013840no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013842 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013843 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013844 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013845 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13846 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013847
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013848no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013850 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013851 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013852 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13854 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013855
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013856no-tlsv13
13857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13858 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13859 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13860 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013861 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13862 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013863
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013864npn <protocols>
13865 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13866 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13867 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013868 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013869 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013870 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13871 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13872 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13873 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13874 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013875
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013876prefer-client-ciphers
13877 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13878 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13879 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013880 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13881 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13882 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013883
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013884process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013885 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13886 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13887 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13888 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13889 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13890 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013891
13892 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13893
13894 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013895 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13896 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13897 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13898 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13899 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013900
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013901proto <name>
13902 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13903 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13904 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013905 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13906 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13907
13908 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13909 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13910 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13911 also reported (flag=HTX).
13912
13913 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13914 a bind line :
13915
13916 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13917 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13918 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13919
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013920 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013921 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013922 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013923 h2" on the bind line.
13924
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013925ssl
13926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013927 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013928 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13929 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013930 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13931 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013932
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013933ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13934 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013935 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13936 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13937 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013938 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13939
13940ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013941 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13942 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13943 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13944 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013945
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013946strict-sni
13947 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13948 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13949 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13950 See the "crt" option for more information.
13951
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013952tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013953 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013954 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013955 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013956 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013957 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13958 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13959 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13960 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13961 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13962 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13963 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13964
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013965tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013966 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013967 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13968 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13969 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13970 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13971 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13972 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13973 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013974 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13975 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13976 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013977
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013978tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13979 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013980 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13981 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13982 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13983 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13984 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13985 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13986 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13987 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13988 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13989 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013990 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13991 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13992
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013993transparent
13994 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13995 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13996 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13997 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13998 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13999 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14000 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14001 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14002 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14003 so check for support with your vendor.
14004
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014005v4v6
14006 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14007 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14008 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14009 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014010 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014011
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014012v6only
14013 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14014 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14015 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014016 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14017 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014019uid <uid>
14020 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14021 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14022 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14023 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14024 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14025
14026user <user>
14027 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14028 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14029 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14030 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14031 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14032
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014033verify [none|optional|required]
14034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14035 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14036 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14037 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14038 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014039 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14040 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14041 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14042 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014043
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140445.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014045------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014047The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14048which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14049arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14050settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14051after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14052Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14053address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014055 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014056 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014057
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014058Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14059keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014061The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014062
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014063addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014065 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14066 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14067 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14068 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14069 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014070
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014071agent-check
14072 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014073 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014074 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14075 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14076 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014077
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014078 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014079 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014080 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014081 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14082 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014083
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14085 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14086 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14087 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14088 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014089
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014090 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014091 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14094 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14095 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014096
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014097 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14098 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14099 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014100
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014101 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014102 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14103 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14104 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14105 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014106 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014107 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014108
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014109 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14110 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014111
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014112 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14113 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14114 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14115 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14116 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14117 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14118 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14119 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14120 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014121
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014122 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14123 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014124 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14125 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14126 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014127 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014128
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014129 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014130 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014131
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014132agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014133 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014134 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14135 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14136 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14137 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14138
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014139agent-inter <delay>
14140 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14141 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14142
14143 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14144 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14145 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14146 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14147 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14148 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14149 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14150 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14151 of backends use the same servers.
14152
14153 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14154
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014155agent-addr <addr>
14156 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14157
14158 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014159 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014160 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14161 hostname, it will be resolved.
14162
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014163agent-port <port>
14164 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14165
14166 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14167
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014168allow-0rtt
14169 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014170 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14171 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014172
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014173alpn <protocols>
14174 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14175 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14176 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014177 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014178 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14179 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14180 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14181 now obsolete NPN extension.
14182 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14183 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14184
14185 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014187backup
14188 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14189 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14190 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14191 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014192 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14193 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014194
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014195ca-file <cafile>
14196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14197 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14198 server's certificate.
14199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014200check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014201 This option enables health checks on a server:
14202 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14203 considered available.
14204 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14205 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14206 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14207 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14208 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14209 set.
14210 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14211 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14212 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14213 exchanges succeed.
14214
14215 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14216 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14217 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14218 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14219 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014220 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014221 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14222
14223 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14224 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14225
14226 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14227 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14228
14229 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14230 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14231 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14232 available.
14233
14234 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14235 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14236 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14237
14238 Example:
14239 # simple tcp check
14240 backend foo
14241 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14242 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14243 backend foo
14244 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14245 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14246 backend foo
14247 option tcp-check
14248 tcp-check connect
14249 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014250
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014251check-send-proxy
14252 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14253 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14254 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14255 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14256 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14257 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14258 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14259
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014260check-alpn <protocols>
14261 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14262 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14263 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14264
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014265check-proto <name>
14266 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14267 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14268 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014269 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14270 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14271
14272 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14273 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14274 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14275 also reported (flag=HTX).
14276
14277 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14278 directive on a server line:
14279
14280 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14281 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14282 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14283 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14284
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014285 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014286 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14287 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14288
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014289check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014290 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014291 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14292 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014293
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014294check-ssl
14295 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14296 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14297 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14298 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014299 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014300 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14301 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014302 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014303 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14304 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014305
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014306check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014307 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014308 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14309 for normal traffic.
14310
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014311ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14313 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14314 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014315 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14316 information and recommendations see e.g.
14317 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14318 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14319 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014320
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014321ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14323 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14324 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14325 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014326 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14327 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14328 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014330cookie <value>
14331 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14332 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14333 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14334 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14335 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14336 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14337 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14338
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014339crl-file <crlfile>
14340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14341 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14342 to verify server's certificate.
14343
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014344crt <cert>
14345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14346 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14347 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14348 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14349 certificate request.
14350
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014351 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14352 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14353 option is set accordingly).
14354
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014355disabled
14356 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14357 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14358 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14359 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14360 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014361 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014362
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014363enabled
14364 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14365 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14366 default value.
14367 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14368 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014370error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014371 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14372 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14373 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014375 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014377fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014378 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14379 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14380 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14381
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014382force-sslv3
14383 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14384 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014385 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014386 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014387
14388force-tlsv10
14389 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014390 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014391 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014392
14393force-tlsv11
14394 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014395 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014396 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014397
14398force-tlsv12
14399 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014400 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014402
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014403force-tlsv13
14404 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14405 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014406 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014408id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014409 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14410 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14411 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014412
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014413init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14414 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14415 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014416 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014417 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14418 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14419 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14420 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14421 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14422 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14423 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14424 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14425 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014426 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014427 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14428 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14429 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14430 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14431 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14432 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014433 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014434
14435 Example:
14436 defaults
14437 # never fail on address resolution
14438 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014440inter <delay>
14441fastinter <delay>
14442downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014443 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14444 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14445 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14446 between checks depending on the server state :
14447
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014448 Server state | Interval used
14449 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14450 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14451 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14452 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14453 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14454 or yet unchecked. |
14455 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14456 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14457 | "inter" otherwise.
14458 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014460 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14461 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14462 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14463 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014464 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14465 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14466 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14467 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14468 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014469
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014470log-proto <logproto>
14471 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14472 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14473 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14474 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014476maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014477 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14478 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014479 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14480 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014481 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14482 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14483 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14484 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14485
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014486 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14487 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14488 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14489 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14490 than 50 concurrent requests.
14491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014492maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014493 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14494 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14495 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14496 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014497 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14498 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14499 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14500 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14501 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14502 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14503 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014504
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014505max-reuse <count>
14506 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14507 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14508 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14509 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14510 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14511 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14512 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14513 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014515minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014516 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14517 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14518 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14519 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14520 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14521 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014522 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014523 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014524
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014525namespace <name>
14526 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14527 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14528 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14529 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14530
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014531no-agent-check
14532 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14533 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14534 default value.
14535 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14536 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14537
14538no-backup
14539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14541 default value.
14542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14543 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14544
14545no-check
14546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14548 default value.
14549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14550 "default-server" "check" setting.
14551
14552no-check-ssl
14553 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14554 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14555 default value.
14556 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14557 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14558
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014559no-send-proxy
14560 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14561 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14562 default value.
14563 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14564 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14565
14566no-send-proxy-v2
14567 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14568 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14569 default value.
14570 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14571 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14572
14573no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14574 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14575 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14576 default value.
14577 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14578 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14579
14580no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14581 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14582 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14583 default value.
14584 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14585 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14586
14587no-ssl
14588 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14589 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14590 default value.
14591 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14592 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14593
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014594 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14595 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14596 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14597
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014598no-ssl-reuse
14599 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14600 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14601 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14602 and for paranoid users.
14603
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014604no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014605 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14606 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014607 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014608
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014609 Supported in default-server: No
14610
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014611no-tls-tickets
14612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14613 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14614 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014615 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14616 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014617 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14618 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14619 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014620 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014621
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014622no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014623 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014624 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14625 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014626 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14627 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014628 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014629
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014630 Supported in default-server: No
14631
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014632no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014633 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014634 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14635 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014636 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14637 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014638 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014639
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014640 Supported in default-server: No
14641
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014642no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014643 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014644 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14645 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014646 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14647 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014648 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014649
14650 Supported in default-server: No
14651
14652no-tlsv13
14653 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14654 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14655 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14656 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14657 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014658 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014659
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014660 Supported in default-server: No
14661
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014662no-verifyhost
14663 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14664 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14665 default value.
14666 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14667 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014668
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014669no-tfo
14670 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14671 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14672 default value.
14673 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14674 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14675
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014676non-stick
14677 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14678 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14679 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14680
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014681npn <protocols>
14682 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14683 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14684 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014685 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014686 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14687 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14688 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014690observe <mode>
14691 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14692 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14693 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14694 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14695 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14696 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014697 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014698
14699 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014701on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014702 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14703 Currently, four modes are available:
14704 - fastinter: force fastinter
14705 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14706 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14707 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14708 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14709
14710 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14711
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014712on-marked-down <action>
14713 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14714 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014715 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14716 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14717 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14718 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14719 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14720 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14721 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14722 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014723
14724 Actions are disabled by default
14725
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014726on-marked-up <action>
14727 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14728 Currently one action is available:
14729 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14730 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14731 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14732 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014733 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14734 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014735 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14736 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14737
14738 Actions are disabled by default
14739
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014740pool-low-conn <max>
14741 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14742 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14743 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14744 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14745 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14746 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14747 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14748 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14749 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14750 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014751 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14752 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14753 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14754 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014755
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014756pool-max-conn <max>
14757 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14758 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14759 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14760 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14761 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14762 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14763
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014764pool-purge-delay <delay>
14765 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014766 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014767 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014769port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014770 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014771 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14772 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14773 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14774 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14775 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014776
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014777proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014778 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14779 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14780 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014781 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14782 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14783
14784 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14785 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14786 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14787 also reported (flag=HTX).
14788
14789 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14790 a server line :
14791
14792 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14793 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14794 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14795 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14796
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014797 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014798 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014800redir <prefix>
14801 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14802 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14803 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14804 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14805 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14806 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14807 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14808 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014809 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014810 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014811 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14812 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14813 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14814 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14815
14816 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014818rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014819 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14820 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14821 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14822
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014823resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14824 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14825 server.
14826
14827 Available options:
14828
14829 * allow-dup-ip
14830 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14831 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14832 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14833 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14834 For such case, simply enable this option.
14835 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14836
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014837 * ignore-weight
14838 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14839 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14840 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14841
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014842 * prevent-dup-ip
14843 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14844 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14845 same fqdn.
14846 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14847
14848 Example:
14849 backend b_myapp
14850 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14851 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14852 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14853
14854 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14855 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14856 it
14857 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14858 different address
14859
14860 Default value: not set
14861
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014862resolve-prefer <family>
14863 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14864 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14865 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14866 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14867
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014868 Default value: ipv6
14869
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014870 Example:
14871
14872 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014873
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014874resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014875 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014876 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014877 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14879 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014880 configured network, another address is selected.
14881
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014882 Example:
14883
14884 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014885
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014886resolvers <id>
14887 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14888 hostname.
14889
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014890 Example:
14891
14892 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014893
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014894 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014895
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014896send-proxy
14897 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14898 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14899 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14900 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014901 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14902 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14903 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14904 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014905 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014906 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14907 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14908 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14909 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14910 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014911 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14912 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014913
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014914send-proxy-v2
14915 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14916 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14917 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14918 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014919 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14920 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14921 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14922 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014923
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014924proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014925 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14926 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14927
14928 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14929 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14930 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14931 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14932 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14933 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14934 connection is supported).
14935 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14936 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14937 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14938 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14939 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14940 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14941 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014942
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014943send-proxy-v2-ssl
14944 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14945 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14946 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14947 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14948 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14949 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14950 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014951 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14952 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014953
14954send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14955 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14956 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14957 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14958 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14959 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14960 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14961 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14962 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014963 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14964 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014966slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014967 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14968 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14969 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14970 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14971 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14972 parameters :
14973
14974 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14975 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14976
14977 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14978 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14979 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14980 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014982 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014983 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14984 seen as failed.
14985
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014986sni <expression>
14987 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14988 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14989 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14990 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014991 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14992 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014993 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014994 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14995 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014996
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014997source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014998source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014999source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015000 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15001 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15002 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15003 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15004
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015005 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15006 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15007 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15008 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15009 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15010 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15011 server.
15012
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015013 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15014 specifying the source address without port(s).
15015
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015016ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015017 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15018 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15019 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15020 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15021 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15022 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015023 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15024 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015025
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015026ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15027 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15028 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15029 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15030
15031ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15032 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15033 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15034 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15035
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015036ssl-reuse
15037 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15038 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15039 default value.
15040 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15041 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15042
15043stick
15044 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15045 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15046 default value.
15047 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15048 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015049
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015050socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015051 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015052 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15053 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15054
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015055tcp-ut <delay>
15056 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015057 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015058 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015059 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015060 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15061 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15062 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15063 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15064 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15065 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15066 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15067 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15068 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15069
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015070tfo
15071 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15072 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15073 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15074 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015075 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015076 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015078track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015079 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15080 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15081 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15082 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015083 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15084
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015085tls-tickets
15086 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15087 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15088 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015089 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15090 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15091 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015092 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015093 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015094
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015095verify [none|required]
15096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015097 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015098 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15099 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015100 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015101 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15102 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15103 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15104 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15105 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15106 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15107 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15108 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015109
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015110verifyhost <hostname>
15111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015112 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15113 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15114 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15115 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15116 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15117 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15118 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15119 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015121weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015122 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15123 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15124 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015125 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15126 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15127 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15128 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15129 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15130 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015131
15132
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151335.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15134-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015135
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015136HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15137using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015138configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015139This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15140can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15141workload.
15142This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15143resolution at run time.
15144Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15145carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15146
15147
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151485.3.1. Global overview
15149----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015150
15151As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15152different steps of the process life:
15153
15154 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15155 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15156 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15157
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015158 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15159 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015160
15161A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15162 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15163 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15164 resolution to know this new IP.
15165
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015166When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015167HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015168SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15169from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015170will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015171will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015172
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015173A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015174 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015175 first valid response.
15176
15177 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15178 servers return an error.
15179
15180
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151815.3.2. The resolvers section
15182----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015183
15184This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015185HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15186contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015187
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015188When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15189uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15190is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15191answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15192
15193When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015194used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015195
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015196 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15197 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15198 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015199
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015200 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15201 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015202
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015203 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15204 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15205 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015206
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015207For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15208following scenarios are possible:
15209
15210 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15211 ignored
15212
15213 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15214 applied
15215
15216 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15217 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15218
15219 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15220 retries the query with a new type
15221
15222 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15223 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015224
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015225As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015226a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015227<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015228
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015229
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015230resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015231 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015232
15233A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15234
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015235accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015236 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015237 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015238 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15239 by RFC 6891)
15240
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015241 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15242 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15243 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15244 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15245 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15246 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015247
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015248nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15249 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15250 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15251 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15252 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15253 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15254 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15255 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15256 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15257 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015258 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15259
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015260parse-resolv-conf
15261 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15262 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15263 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15264
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015265hold <status> <period>
15266 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15267 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015268 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015269 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015270 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15271 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15272 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15273
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015274 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015275
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015276resolve_retries <nb>
15277 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15278 giving up.
15279 Default value: 3
15280
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015281 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15282 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15283 type.
15284
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015285timeout <event> <time>
15286 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15287 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15288 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015289 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15290 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015291 Default value: 1s
15292 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015293 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015294 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015295 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15296 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15297
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015298 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015299
15300 resolvers mydns
15301 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15302 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015303 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015304 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015305 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015306 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015307 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015308 hold other 30s
15309 hold refused 30s
15310 hold nx 30s
15311 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015312 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015313 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015314
15315
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153166. Cache
15317---------
15318
15319HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15320(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15321RAM.
15322
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015323The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15324blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015325
15326If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15327independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15328when we try to allocate a new one.
15329
15330The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15331
15332It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15333"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15334for more details.
15335
15336When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15337replaced by "<CACHE>".
15338
15339
153406.1. Limitation
15341----------------
15342
15343The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15344
15345- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015346- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15347 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15348 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015349- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15350- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015351- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15352 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15353 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015354- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15355 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015356- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15357 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15358 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015359
15360- If the request is not a GET
15361- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15362- If the request contains an Authorization header
15363
15364
153656.2. Setup
15366-----------
15367
15368To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15369the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15370
15371
153726.2.1. Cache section
15373---------------------
15374
15375cache <name>
15376 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15377 size of cache is mandatory.
15378
15379total-max-size <megabytes>
15380 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15381 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15382
15383max-object-size <bytes>
15384 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15385 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15386 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15387
15388max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015389 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015390 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15391 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15392 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15393 default.
15394
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015395process-vary <on/off>
15396 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015397 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15398 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15399 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015400 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015401
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015402max-secondary-entries <number>
15403 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15404 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15405 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15406
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015407
154086.2.2. Proxy section
15409---------------------
15410
15411http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15412 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15413 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15414 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15415 after this one.
15416
15417http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15418 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15419 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15420 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15421 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15422
15423
15424Example:
15425
15426 backend bck1
15427 mode http
15428
15429 http-request cache-use foobar
15430 http-response cache-store foobar
15431 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15432
15433 cache foobar
15434 total-max-size 4
15435 max-age 240
15436
15437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154387. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15439----------------------------------
15440
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015441HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15443The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15444these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15445but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15446data called patterns.
15447
15448
154497.1. ACL basics
15450---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015451
15452The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15453content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15454from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15455simple :
15456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015458 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15460 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15463adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015464
15465In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015468
15469This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15470Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15471and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015472an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15473conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15474as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15475are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015476
15477ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15478'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15479which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15480
15481There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15482performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15485specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15486this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015487methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15488ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489
15490Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15491 - boolean
15492 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15493 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15494 - string
15495 - data block
15496
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015497Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15498converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15499would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15500The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15501which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15502
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015503Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15504keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15505fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15506which are summarized in the table below :
15507
15508 +---------------------+-----------------+
15509 | Sample or converter | Default |
15510 | output type | matching method |
15511 +---------------------+-----------------+
15512 | boolean | bool |
15513 +---------------------+-----------------+
15514 | integer | int |
15515 +---------------------+-----------------+
15516 | ip | ip |
15517 +---------------------+-----------------+
15518 | string | str |
15519 +---------------------+-----------------+
15520 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15521 +---------------------+-----------------+
15522
15523Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15524matching method, see below.
15525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15527 - boolean
15528 - integer or integer range
15529 - IP address / network
15530 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15531 - regular expression
15532 - hex block
15533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015534The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15535
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015536 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15537 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015539 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015540 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015541 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015542 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15545read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15546if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15547lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15548will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15549beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015550a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15552exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15553
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015554The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15555parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15556ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15557a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15558check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15559
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015560The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15561socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15562file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15565loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15566
15567 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15568
15569In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15570the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15571case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15572as well.
15573
15574The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15575sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15576do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15577methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15578is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015579obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15581default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15582that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15583string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15584
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015585The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15586By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15587string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15588resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015589server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015590waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015591flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15592function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15595sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15596be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015597
15598 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15599 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15601 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15602 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15603 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015604
15605 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15606 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015608
15609 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015611
15612 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015615 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015616 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15617
15618 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15619 binary or string samples.
15620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15622 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15625 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15626 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15629 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15632 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15635 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15638 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015639 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15642 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15643 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015644
15645For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15646request, it is possible to do :
15647
15648 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15649
15650In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15651buffer, one would use the following acl :
15652
15653 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15654
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015655On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15656possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15657
15658 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15661criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15662method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15663to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15664criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15665the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015668the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15669For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15672 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15673 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15674 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015675
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015676
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015677The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15678types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15679combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15680brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15681default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 +-------------------------------------------------+
15684 | Input sample type |
15685 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015686 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15688 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15689 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015690 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015692 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015694 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015696 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015698 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015700 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015702 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015704 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015706 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015708 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015710 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15712 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015714
15715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157167.1.1. Matching booleans
15717------------------------
15718
15719In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15720Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15721When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15722that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15723
15724Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15725return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15726"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157297.1.2. Matching integers
15730------------------------
15731
15732Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15733enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15734to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15735
15736Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15737matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15738lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015739
15740For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15741unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15742representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15743
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015744As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15745two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15746instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15747ranges and operators.
15748
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015749For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015750operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15751Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15752of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015754Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015755
15756 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15757 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15758 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15759 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15760 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015762For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015763
15764 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15765
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015766This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15767
15768 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157717.1.3. Matching strings
15772-----------------------
15773
15774String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15775different forms :
15776
15777 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015778 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779
15780 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015781 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015782
15783 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15784 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15785
15786 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15787 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15788
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015789 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15791 matches.
15792
15793 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15794 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15795 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015796
15797String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15798exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15799characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15800string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15801to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015802before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015804Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15805(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15806Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15807
15808Example:
15809 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15810 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158137.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15814---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015815
15816Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15817they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15818possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15819passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15820the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015821the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15822match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
15824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158257.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15826-------------------------------------
15827
15828It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15829not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15830a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15831to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15832digits may be used upper or lower case.
15833
15834Example :
15835 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15836 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15837
15838
158397.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15840---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015841
15842IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15843netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15844within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015845host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015846difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15847at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15848does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15849parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015850
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015851The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15852abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15853
15854 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15855 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15856 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15857 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15858 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15859 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15860 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15861 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15862
15863Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15864192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15865
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015866IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15867Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15868trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15869IPv6 patterns.
15870
15871HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15872following situations :
15873 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15874 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15875 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15876 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15877 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15878 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15879 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15880 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15881 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15882 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884
158857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15886----------------------------------
15887
15888Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15889combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15890
15891 - AND (implicit)
15892 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15893 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15900indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15903"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15904requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15905is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15906
15907 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015908 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15909 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15910 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911
15912To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15913and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15914
15915 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15916 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15917 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15918 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15919
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15922 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15923 use_backend www if host_www
15924
15925It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15926expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15927be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15928the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15929
15930 The following rule :
15931
15932 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015933 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934
15935 Can also be written that way :
15936
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015937 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
15939It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15940to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15941simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15942sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15943good use is the following :
15944
15945 With named ACLs :
15946
15947 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15948 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15949 monitor fail if site_dead
15950
15951 With anonymous ACLs :
15952
15953 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15954
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015955See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15956keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
15958
159597.3. Fetching samples
15960---------------------
15961
15962Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15963against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15964sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15965ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15966of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15967available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15968
15969This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15970Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15971compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15972deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15973
15974The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15975matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15976method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15977indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15978
15979As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15980when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15981mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15982the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15983ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15984
15985Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15986multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15987when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15989are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15991all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15992
15993Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15994 - name
15995 - name(arg1)
15996 - name(arg1,arg2)
15997
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015998
159997.3.1. Converters
16000-----------------
16001
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016002Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16003of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16004is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16005was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016006has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016007unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16008
16009These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16010sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16011the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016012support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016013
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016014A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16015support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16016supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16017(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16018bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016021
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001602251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16023 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16024 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16025 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16026 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16027 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16028
16029 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016030 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16031 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016032 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16033 frontend http-in
16034 bind *:8081
16035 default_backend servers
16036 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16037 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16038
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016039add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016040 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016041 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016042 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16043 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016044 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016045 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16046 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16047 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16048 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016050 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016051
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016052aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16053 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16054 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16055 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16056 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16057 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16058 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16059
16060 Example:
16061 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16062 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16063
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016064and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016065 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016066 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016067 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16068 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016069 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016070 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16071 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16072 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16073 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016074 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016075 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016076
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016077b64dec
16078 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16079 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016080 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16081 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016082
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016083base64
16084 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016085 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016086 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16087 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016088
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016089bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016090 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016091 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016092 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016093 presence of a flag).
16094
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016095bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16096 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16097 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016098 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016099
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016100concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16101 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16102 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16103 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16104 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16105 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16106 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16107 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16108 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16109 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16110 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016111 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016112 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016113 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16114 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016115
16116 Example:
16117 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16118 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16119 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016120 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016121 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16122
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016123cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016124 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16125 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016126
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016127crc32([<avalanche>])
16128 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16129 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16130 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16131 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16132 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16133 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16134 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16135 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16136 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16137 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016138 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16139
16140crc32c([<avalanche>])
16141 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16142 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16143 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16144 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16145 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16146 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16147 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16148 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016149
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016150cut_crlf
16151 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16152 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16153 updated.
16154
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016155da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016156 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16157 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16158 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16159 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016160 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016161 configuration language.
16162
16163 Example:
16164 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016165 bind *:8881
16166 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016167 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016168
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016169debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16170 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16171 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16172 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16173 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16174 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16175 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16176 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16177 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16178 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16179 printable sample types.
16180
16181 Example:
16182 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016183
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016184digest(<algorithm>)
16185 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16186 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16187
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016188 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016189 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16190
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016191div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016192 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16193 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016194 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016195 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16196 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016197 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016198 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16199 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16200 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16201 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016203 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016204
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016205djb2([<avalanche>])
16206 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16207 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16208 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16209 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16210 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16211 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16212 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016213 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16214 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016215
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016216even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016217 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016218 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16219
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016220field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16221 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16222 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16223 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16224 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16225 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16226 fields.
16227
16228 Example :
16229 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16230 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16231 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16232 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16233 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016234
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016235fix_is_valid
16236 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16237 Information eXchange):
16238
16239 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16240 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016241 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016242 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016243 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016244 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16245 checksum
16246
16247 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16248 the server can be parsed.
16249
16250 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16251 message, false if not.
16252
16253 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16254
16255 Example:
16256 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16257 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16258
16259fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16260 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16261 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16262 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16263 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016264 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016265 added.
16266
16267 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16268 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16269 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16270 fix_is_valid converter.
16271
16272 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16273
16274 Example:
16275 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16276 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16277 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16278 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16279 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016281hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016282 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016283 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016285 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016286
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016287hex2i
16288 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016289 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016290
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016291htonl
16292 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16293 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16294 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16295 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16296
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016297hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016298 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16299 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16300 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16301 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16302
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016303 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016304 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16305
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016306http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016307 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16308 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016309 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16310 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16311 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16312 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16313 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16314 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16315 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16316 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016318iif(<true>,<false>)
16319 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16320 string otherwise.
16321
16322 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016323 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016324
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016325in_table(<table>)
16326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16328 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016329 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016330 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16331
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016332ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016333 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016334 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016335 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16336 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16337 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16338 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16339 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016340
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016341json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016342 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016343 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016344 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016345 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16346 of errors:
16347 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16348 bytes, ...)
16349 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16350 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16351
16352 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16353 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16354 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16355 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16356 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16357 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016358 - "ascii" : never fails;
16359 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16360 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016361 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016362 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016363 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16364 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16365
16366 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016367 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016368
16369 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016370 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016371 capture request header user-agent len 150
16372 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016373
16374 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16375 GET / HTTP/1.0
16376 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16377
16378 Output log:
16379 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16380
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016381json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16382 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16383 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16384 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16385 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16386
16387 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16388 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16389
16390 Example:
16391 # get a integer value from the request body
16392 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16393 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16394
16395 # get a key with '.' in the name
16396 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16397 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16398
16399 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16400 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16401
16402 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16403 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16404
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016405language(<value>[,<default>])
16406 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16407 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16408 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16409 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16410 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16411 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16412 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16413 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16414 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016415 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016416 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16417 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016419 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016420
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016421 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16422 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016424 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16425 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16426 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16427 use_backend spanish if es
16428 use_backend french if fr
16429 use_backend english if en
16430 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016431
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016432length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016433 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16434 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16435 type. The result is of type integer.
16436
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016437lower
16438 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16439 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16440 type. The result is of type string.
16441
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016442ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16443 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16444 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16445 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16446 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16447 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16448 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16449
16450 Example :
16451
16452 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016454 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16455
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016456ltrim(<chars>)
16457 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16458 representation of the input sample.
16459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016460map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16461map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16462map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16463 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16464 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16465 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16466 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16467 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16468 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16469 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16470 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016471
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016472 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16473 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16474 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016475
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016476 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016477 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016478
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016479 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16480 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16481 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16482 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016483 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16484 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016485 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16486 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16487 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16488 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16489 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16490 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16491 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16492 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016493 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16494 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16495 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016496 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16497 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16498 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16499 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16500 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016501
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016502 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16503 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16504 the corresponding match text.
16505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016506 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16507 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16508 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16509 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16510 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016512 Example :
16513
16514 # this is a comment and is ignored
16515 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16516 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16517 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16518 | | | `---------- value
16519 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16520 | `---------------------------- key
16521 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16522
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016523mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016524 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16525 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016526 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016527 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016528 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016529 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16530 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16531 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16532 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016533 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016534 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016535
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016536mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016537 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16538 <packettype>.
16539 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16540 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16541 from.
16542 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16543 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16544 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16545
16546 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16547 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16548 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16549 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16550
16551 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16552 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16553 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16554 packets only):
16555 17: Session Expiry Interval
16556 33: Receive Maximum
16557 39: Maximum Packet Size
16558 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16559 25: Request Response Information
16560 23: Request Problem Information
16561 21: Authentication Method
16562 22: Authentication Data
16563 18: Will Delay Interval
16564 1: Payload Format Indicator
16565 2: Message Expiry Interval
16566 3: Content Type
16567 8: Response Topic
16568 9: Correlation Data
16569 Not supported yet:
16570 38: User Property
16571
16572 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16573 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16574 packets only):
16575 17: Session Expiry Interval
16576 33: Receive Maximum
16577 36: Maximum QoS
16578 37: Retain Available
16579 39: Maximum Packet Size
16580 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16581 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16582 31: Reason String
16583 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16584 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16585 42: Shared Subscription Available
16586 19: Server Keep Alive
16587 26: Response Information
16588 28: Server Reference
16589 21: Authentication Method
16590 22: Authentication Data
16591 Not supported yet:
16592 38: User Property
16593
16594 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16595 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16596 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16597 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16598
16599 Example:
16600
16601 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16602 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16603 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16604 if data_in_buffer
16605 # do the same as above
16606 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16607 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16608 if data_in_buffer
16609
16610mqtt_is_valid
16611 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16612
16613 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16614 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16615 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16616 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16617
16618 Example:
16619
16620 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016621 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016622
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016623mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016624 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016625 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16626 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016627 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016628 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16632 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016634 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016635 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016636
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016637nbsrv
16638 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16639 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16640 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16641 map lookup.
16642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016643neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016644 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16645 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16646 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16647 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016648
16649not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016650 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016651 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016652 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016653 absence of a flag).
16654
16655odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016656 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016657 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16658
16659or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016660 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016661 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016662 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16663 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16667 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16668 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016670 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016671
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016672protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16673 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16674 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16675 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16676 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16677 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16678 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16679 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16680 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16681 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16682 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16683 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16684
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016685regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016686 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16687 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16688 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16689 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16690 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16691 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16692 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16693 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16694 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016695 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16696 of characters with other ones.
16697
16698 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16699 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16700 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16701 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16702 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16703 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016704
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016705 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016706
16707 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16708 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16709 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016710 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016711
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016712 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16713 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16714
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016715 # capture groups and backreferences
16716 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016717 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016718 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16719
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016720capture-req(<id>)
16721 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16722 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16723
16724 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016725 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16726 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016727
16728capture-res(<id>)
16729 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16730 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16731
16732 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016733 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16734 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016735
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016736rtrim(<chars>)
16737 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16738 of the input sample.
16739
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016740sdbm([<avalanche>])
16741 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16742 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16743 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16744 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16745 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16746 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16747 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016748 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16749 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016750
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016751secure_memcmp(<var>)
16752 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16753 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16754 match.
16755
16756 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16757 performed in constant time.
16758
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016759 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016760 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16761
16762 Example :
16763
16764 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16765 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16766 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16767 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16768
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016769set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016770 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16771 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16772 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016773 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016774 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16775 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016776 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016777 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16778 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016779 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016780 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016781
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016782sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016783 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016784 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16785
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016786sha2([<bits>])
16787 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16788 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16789
16790 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16791 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16792
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016793 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016794 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16795
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016796srv_queue
16797 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16798 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16799 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16800 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16801 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16802
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016803strcmp(<var>)
16804 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16805 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16806 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16807 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16808 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16809 shorter).
16810
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016811 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16812 strings in constant time.
16813
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016814 Example :
16815
16816 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16817 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16818 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16819
16820
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016821sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016822 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16823 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016824 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016825 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16826 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016827 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016828 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16829 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016830 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016831 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16832 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016833 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016834 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016835
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016836table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16840 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16841 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16842 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16843
16844
16845table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16846 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16847 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16848 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16849 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16850 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16851 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16852
16853table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16854 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16855 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016856 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016857 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16858 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16859
16860table_conn_cur(<table>)
16861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16864 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16865 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16866
16867table_conn_rate(<table>)
16868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16871 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16872 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16873
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016874table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16878 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16879 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16880 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16881 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16882 data-type).
16883 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16884
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016885table_gpt0(<table>)
16886 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16887 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16888 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16889 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16890 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16891
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016892table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16896 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16897 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16898 between 0 and 99.
16899 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16900 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16901 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16902 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16903
16904table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16908 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16909 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16910 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16911 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16912 value 0.
16913 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16914 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16915 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16916
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016917table_gpc0(<table>)
16918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16921 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16922 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16923
16924table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16928 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16929 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16930 sample fetch keyword.
16931
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016932table_gpc1(<table>)
16933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16936 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16937 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16938
16939table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16943 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16944 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16945 sample fetch keyword.
16946
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016947table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016951 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16952 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16953
16954table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16957 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16958 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16959 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16960 keyword.
16961
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016962table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16965 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16966 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16967 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16968
16969table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16972 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16973 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16974 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16975 keyword.
16976
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016977table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016980 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016981 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16982 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16983
16984table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16985 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16986 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16987 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16988 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16989 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16990 keyword.
16991
16992table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016995 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016996 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16997 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16998 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16999 keyword.
17000
17001table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017005 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17006 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17007 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17008 keyword.
17009
17010table_server_id(<table>)
17011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17014 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17015 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17016 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17017
17018table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017022 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17023 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17024 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17025 keyword.
17026
17027table_sess_rate(<table>)
17028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17031 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17032 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17033 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17034 keyword.
17035
17036table_trackers(<table>)
17037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17040 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17041 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17042 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17043 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17044 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17045 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17046 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17047
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017048ub64dec
17049 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17050 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17051 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17052
17053 Example:
17054 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17055 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17056
17057ub64enc
17058 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17059
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017060upper
17061 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17062 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17063 type. The result is of type string.
17064
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017065url_dec([<in_form>])
17066 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17067 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17068 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17069 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17070 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17071 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017072
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017073url_enc([<enc_type>])
17074 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17075 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17076 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17077 optional argument is here for future changes.
17078
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017079ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017080 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017081 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17082 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17083 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017084 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17085 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17086 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17087 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017088 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017089 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17090 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017091
17092 Example:
17093 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17094 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17095
17096 message Point {
17097 int32 latitude = 1;
17098 int32 longitude = 2;
17099 }
17100
17101 message PPoint {
17102 Point point = 59;
17103 }
17104
17105 message Rectangle {
17106 // One corner of the rectangle.
17107 PPoint lo = 48;
17108 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17109 PPoint hi = 49;
17110 }
17111
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017112 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17113 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17114 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017115
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017116 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17117 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017118 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017119 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17120
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017121 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017122
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017123 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017124
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017125 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17126 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17127 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017128
17129 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17130 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17131 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17132
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017133 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17134 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17135 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017136
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017137
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017138unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017139 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17140 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17141 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17142 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17143 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17144 response),
17145 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17146 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17147 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17148 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17149
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017150utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17151 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17152 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17153 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17154 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17155 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17156 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17157
17158 Example :
17159
17160 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017161 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017162 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17163
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017164word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17165 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17166 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17167 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017168 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017169 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17170 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17171
17172 Example :
17173 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17174 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17175 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17176 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17177 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017178 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017179
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017180wt6([<avalanche>])
17181 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17182 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17183 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17184 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17185 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17186 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17187 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017188 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17189 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017190
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017191xor(<value>)
17192 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017193 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017194 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017195 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017196 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017197 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17198 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017199 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017200 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17201 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017203 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017204
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017205xxh3([<seed>])
17206 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17207 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17208 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17209 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17210 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17211 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17212 considered as cryptographically secure.
17213
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017214xxh32([<seed>])
17215 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17216 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17217 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17218 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17219 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17220 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17221 as cryptographically secure.
17222
17223xxh64([<seed>])
17224 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17225 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17226 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17227 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17228 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17229 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17230 as cryptographically secure.
17231
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017232
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172337.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234--------------------------------------------
17235
17236A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17237not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17238"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17239The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17240
17241always_false : boolean
17242 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17243 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17244
17245always_true : boolean
17246 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17247 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17248
17249avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017250 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017251 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17252 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17253 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17254 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17255 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17256 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17257 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17258 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17259 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17260 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17261 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17262 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17263 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017266 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17267 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17268 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17269 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017270 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17271
17272be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17274 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17275 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17276 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17277 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017278 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17279 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017280
17281 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17282 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17283 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17286 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17287 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17288 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017289 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17291 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017292
17293 Example :
17294 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17295 backend dynamic
17296 mode http
17297 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17298 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017300bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017301 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17302 of the string.
17303
17304bool(<bool>) : bool
17305 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17306 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017308connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17309 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017310 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17312 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017313
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017314 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017315 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017316 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17317
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017318 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17319 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017320
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017321 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017322 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017324 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017325 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017327 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017328
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017329 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17330 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017332 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017333
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017334cpu_calls : integer
17335 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17336 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17337 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17338 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17339 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17340 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17341
17342cpu_ns_avg : integer
17343 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17344 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17345 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17346 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17347 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17348 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17349 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17350 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17351 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17352 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17353 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17354
17355cpu_ns_tot : integer
17356 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17357 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17358 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17359 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17360 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17361 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17362 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17363 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17364 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17365 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17366 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17367 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17368 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17369
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017370date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017371 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017372
17373 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17374 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17375 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017376 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17377
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017378 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17379 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17380 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17381 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17382 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17383
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017384 Example :
17385
17386 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17387 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017388
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017389 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17390 # millisecond granularity
17391 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17392
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017393date_us : integer
17394 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17395 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17396 from the same timeval structure.
17397
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017398distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17399 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17400 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17401 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17402 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017403 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017404 list of supported tokens.
17405
17406distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17407 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17408 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17409 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17410 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017411 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017412 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17413 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17414 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17415 supported tokens.
17416
17417 Example :
17418 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17419 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17420 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17421 # send large files to the big farm
17422 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17423
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017424env(<name>) : string
17425 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17426 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17427 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17428 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17429 certain way.
17430
17431 Examples :
17432 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17433 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17434
17435 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17436 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17439 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017440 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17441 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17443 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017444 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17446 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017447
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017448fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17450 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17451 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017453fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17454 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17455 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17456 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17457 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17458 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17459 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17460 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17461 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017462
17463 Example :
17464 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17465 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17466 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17467 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17468 frontend mail
17469 bind :25
17470 mode tcp
17471 maxconn 100
17472 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17473 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17474 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17475 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017476
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017477hostname : string
17478 Returns the system hostname.
17479
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017480int(<integer>) : signed integer
17481 Returns a signed integer.
17482
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017483ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17484 Returns an ipv4.
17485
17486ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17487 Returns an ipv6.
17488
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017489lat_ns_avg : integer
17490 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17491 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17492 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17493 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17494 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17495 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17496 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17497 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17498 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017499 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17500 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17501 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17502 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17503 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17504 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017505
17506lat_ns_tot : integer
17507 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17508 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17509 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17510 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17511 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17512 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17513 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17514 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17515 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017516 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17517 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17518 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17519 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17520 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017521 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17522 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17523 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17524 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17525 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17526 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17527
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017528meth(<method>) : method
17529 Returns a method.
17530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17533 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17534 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017535 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17536 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17537 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017538
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017539prio_class : integer
17540 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17541 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17542 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17543
17544prio_offset : integer
17545 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17546 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17547 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17548 set-priority-offset".
17549
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017550proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017551 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17552 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017555 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17556 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17557 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17559 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17560 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17561 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17562 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17563
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017564rand([<range>]) : integer
17565 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17566 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17567 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17568 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17569 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17572 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17573 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17574 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17575 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17576 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017577 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17578 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17579
17580srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17581 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17582 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17583 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17584 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17585 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17586 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17587 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17588
17589 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17590 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591
17592srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17593 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17594 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17595 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017596 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017597 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17598 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17599 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17600
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017601srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17602 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17603 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17604 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17605 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17606 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17607 fetch methods.
17608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17610 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17611 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017612 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17614 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 overloading servers).
17617
17618 Example :
17619 # Redirect to a separate back
17620 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17621 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17622 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17623
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017624srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017625 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17626 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17627 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17628
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017629srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017630 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17631 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17632 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17633
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017634srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017635 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17636 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17637 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17638
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017639stopping : boolean
17640 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17641 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17642 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17643
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017644str(<string>) : string
17645 Returns a string.
17646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17648 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17649 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17650
17651table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17652 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17653 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17654 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17655
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017656thread : integer
17657 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17658 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17659 and debugging purposes.
17660
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017661uuid([<version>]) : string
17662 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17663 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17664 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17665
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017666var(<var-name>) : undefined
17667 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017668 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17669 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017670 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017671 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17672 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017673 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017674 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017676 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017677 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017680----------------------------------
17681
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017682The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17684methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17685sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17686TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017687the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17688counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017689"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17690used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17691can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17692Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17693table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17694tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17695currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017696
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017697bc_dst : ip
17698 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17699 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17700 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17701 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17702
17703bc_dst_port : integer
17704 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017705 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017706
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017707bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017708 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17709 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17710 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17711
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017712bc_src : ip
17713 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017714 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017715 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17716 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17717
17718bc_src_port : integer
17719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017720 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722be_id : integer
17723 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017724 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17725 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017727be_name : string
17728 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017729 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17730 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017731
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017732be_server_timeout : integer
17733 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17734 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17735 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17736
17737be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17738 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17739 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17740 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17741
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017742cur_server_timeout : integer
17743 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17744 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17745 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17746
17747cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17748 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17749 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17750 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752dst : ip
17753 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17754 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17755 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17756 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017757 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17758 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17759 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17760 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17761 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17762 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763
17764dst_conn : integer
17765 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17766 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17767 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17768 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17769 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17770 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17771 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17772 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017773
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017774dst_is_local : boolean
17775 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17776 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17777 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17778 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017779 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017780 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17781 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17782 it only once per connection.
17783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784dst_port : integer
17785 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17786 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17787 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17788 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17789 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17790 an HTTP header.
17791
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017792fc_conn_err : integer
17793 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17794 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17795 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
17796 decribed in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
17797 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17798
17799fc_conn_err_str : string
17800 Returns an error message decribing what problem happened on the current
17801 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17802 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17803 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17804
17805 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17806 | ID | message |
17807 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17808 | 0 | "Success" |
17809 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17810 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17811 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17812 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17813 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17814 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17815 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17816 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17817 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17818 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17819 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17820 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17821 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17822 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17823 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17824 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17825 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17826 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17827 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17828 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17829 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17830 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17831 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17832 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17833 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17834 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17835 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17836 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17837 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17838 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17839 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17840 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17841 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17842 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17843 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17844 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17845 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17846 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17847 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17848 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17849 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17850 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17851 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17852
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017853fc_http_major : integer
17854 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17855 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17856 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17857
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017858fc_pp_authority : string
17859 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17860 if any.
17861
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017862fc_pp_unique_id : string
17863 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17864 if any.
17865
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017866fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17867 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17868 header.
17869
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017870fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17871 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17872 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17873 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17874 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17875 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17876 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17877
17878fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17879 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17880 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17881 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17882 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17883 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17884 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17885
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017886fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017887 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17888 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17889 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17890 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17891
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017892fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017893 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17894 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17895 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17896 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17897
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017898fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017899 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17900 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17901 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17902 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17903
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017904fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017905 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17906 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17907 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17908 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17909
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017910fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017911 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17912 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17913 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17914 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17915
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017916fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017917 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17918 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17919 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17920 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17921
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017922fe_defbe : string
17923 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17924 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017926fe_id : integer
17927 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017928 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017929 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17930
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017931fe_name : string
17932 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17933 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17934 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17935
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017936fe_client_timeout : integer
17937 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17938 current frontend.
17939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017940sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017941sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17942sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17943sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017944 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17945 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17946 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017948sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017949sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17950sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17951sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017952 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17953 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17954 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17955
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017956sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17957 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
17958 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
17959 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
17960 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17961 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17962 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
17963 will always return zero.
17964 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17965 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017967sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017968sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17969sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17970sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017971 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17972 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017973 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17974 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17975 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017976
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017977 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017978 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17979 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017980 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17981 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17982 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017983 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17984 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17985
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017986sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17987sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17988sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17989sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17990 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17991 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17992 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17993 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17994 when a first ACL was verified.
17995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017996sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017997sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17998sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17999sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018000 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018001 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18002
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018003sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018004sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18005sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18006sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018007 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18008 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18009 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18010
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018011sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018012sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18013sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18014sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018015 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18016 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18017 See also src_conn_rate.
18018
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018019sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18020 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18021 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18022 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18023 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18024 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18025 index, zero is returned.
18026 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18027 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18028
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018029sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018030sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18031sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18032sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018033 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018034 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018035
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018036sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18037sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18038sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18039sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18040 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18041 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18042
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018043sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18044 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18045 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18046 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18047 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18048 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18049 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18050 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18051
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018052sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18053sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18054sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18055sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18056 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18057 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18058
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018059sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18060 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18061 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18062 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18063 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18064 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18065 between 0 and 2.
18066 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18067 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18068 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18069 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18070 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018072sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018073sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18074sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18075sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018076 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18077 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18078 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018079 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18080 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18081 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018082
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018083sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18084sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18085sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18086sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18087 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18088 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18089 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18090 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18091 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18092 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18093
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018094sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018095sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18096sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18097sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018098 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018099 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18100 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18101
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018102sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018103sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18104sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18105sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018106 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18107 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18108 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18109 src_http_err_rate.
18110
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018111sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18112sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18113sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18114sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18115 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18116 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18117 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18118
18119sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18120sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18121sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18122sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18124 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18125 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18126 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18127
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018128sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018129sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18130sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18131sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018132 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018133 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18134 src_http_req_cnt.
18135
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018136sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018137sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18138sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018140 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18141 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18142 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18143 src_http_req_rate.
18144
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018145sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18146 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18147 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18148 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18149 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18150 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18151 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18152 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18153 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18154 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018156sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018157sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18158sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18159sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018161 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18162 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18163 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18164 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018165
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018166 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018167 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18168 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018169 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18170
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018171sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18172sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18173sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18174sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18175 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18176 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18177 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18178 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18179 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18180
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018181sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018182sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18183sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18184sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018185 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18186 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18187 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018193 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18194 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18195 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018197sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018198sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18199sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18200sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018202 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18203 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18204 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018205 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018206 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018208sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018209sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18210sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18211sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018212 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18213 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18214 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18215 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18216 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018217 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018218
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018219sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018220sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18221sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18222sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018223 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18224 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18225 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18226
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018227sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018228sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18229sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18230sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018231 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18232 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018233 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018234 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18235 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18237 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18238 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240so_id : integer
18241 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18242 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18243 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018244
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018245so_name : string
18246 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18247 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18248 strings instead of integers.
18249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018251 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18253 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18254 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018255 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18256 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18257 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018258 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18259 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18260 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18261 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18262 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18263 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18264 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018265
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018266 Example:
18267 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18268 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18271 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18272 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18273 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018274 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18277 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18278 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018279 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018280 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018281
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018282src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18283 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18284 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18285 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18286 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18287 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18288 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18289 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18290 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18293 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18294 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18295 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18296 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18297 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18298 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018299
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018300 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018301 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18302 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18303 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18304 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018305 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018306 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18307 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18308
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018309src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18310 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18311 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18312 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18313 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18314 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18315 was verified.
18316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018318 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018320 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018321 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018324 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18326 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018327 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18330 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18331 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18332 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018333 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018334
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018335src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18336 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18337 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18338 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18339 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18340 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18341 is returned.
18342 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18343 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18344 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018347 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018349 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018350 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018352src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18353 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18354 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18355 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18356 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18357
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018358src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18359 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18360 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18361 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18362 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18363 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18364 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18365
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018366src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18367 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18368 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18369 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18370 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18371
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018372src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18373 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18374 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18375 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18376 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18377 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18378 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18379 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18380 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18381 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18382 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018385 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018387 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18388 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018389 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18390 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18391 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018392
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018393src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18394 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18395 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18396 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18397 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18398 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18399 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18400 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018403 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018405 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018406 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018409src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18410 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18411 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18412 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18413 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018414 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018415
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018416src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18417 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18418 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018419 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018420 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18421 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18422
18423src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18424 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18425 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18426 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18427 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18428 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18429 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018432 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18434 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018435 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18438 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18439 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18440 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018441 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018442 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018443
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018444src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18445 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18446 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18447 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18448 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18449 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18450 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18451 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18452 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18455 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18456 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18457 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018458 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018459 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18460 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018461
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018462 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018463 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018464 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018465 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018466
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018467src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18468 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18469 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18470 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18471 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18472 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18473 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18474
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018475src_is_local : boolean
18476 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18477 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18478 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18479 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018480 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018481 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18482 once per connection.
18483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018484src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018485 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18486 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18487 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18488 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18489 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018492 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18493 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18494 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18495 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18496 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018498src_port : integer
18499 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18500 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18501 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18502 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018504src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018505 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018506 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18507 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18508 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018509 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18512 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18513 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18514 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18515 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018516 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18519 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18520 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18521 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18522 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18523 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18524 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18525 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18526 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018527
18528 Example :
18529 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18530 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18531 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18532 listen ssh
18533 bind :22
18534 mode tcp
18535 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018536 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018538 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018540srv_id : integer
18541 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18542 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018543 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018544
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018545srv_name : string
18546 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18547 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018548 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185507.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018551----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018552
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018553The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018554closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18555when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18556usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018557future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018558
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001855951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18560 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18561 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18562 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18563 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18564 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18565
18566 Example :
18567 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18568 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18569 # the request.
18570 frontend http-in
18571 bind *:8081
18572 default_backend servers
18573 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18574 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18575
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018576ssl_bc : boolean
18577 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18578 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018579 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18580 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018581
18582ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18583 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018584 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18585 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018586
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018587ssl_bc_alpn : string
18588 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18589 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018590 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018591 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18592 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18593 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18594 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18595 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018596 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18597 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018598
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018599ssl_bc_cipher : string
18600 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018601 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18602 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018603
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018604ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18605 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18606 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18607 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018608 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018609
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018610ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18611 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18612 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018613 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18614 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018615
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018616ssl_bc_npn : string
18617 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18618 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018619 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018620 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18621 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18622 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18623 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018624 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18625 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018626
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018627ssl_bc_protocol : string
18628 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018629 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18630 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018631
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018632ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018633 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018634 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018635 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18636 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018637
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018638ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18639 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18640 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18641 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018642 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018643
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018644ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18645 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18646 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018647 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18648 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018649
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018650ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18651 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18652 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18653 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018654 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018655
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018656ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18657 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018658 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18659 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18662 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18663 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18664 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18665 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18666 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018668ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18669 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18670 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18671 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18672 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018673
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018674ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018675 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18676 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18677 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018678 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018679 does not support resumed sessions.
18680
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018681ssl_c_der : binary
18682 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18683 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18684 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686ssl_c_err : integer
18687 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18688 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18689 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18690 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18691 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018692
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018693ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18695 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18696 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18697 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18698 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18699 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18700 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18701 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018702 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18703 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18704 LDAP v3.
18705 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18706 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018708ssl_c_key_alg : string
18709 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18710 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18711 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713ssl_c_notafter : string
18714 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18715 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18716 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018718ssl_c_notbefore : string
18719 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18720 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18721 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018722
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018723ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18725 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18726 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18727 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18728 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18729 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18730 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18731 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018732 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18733 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18734 LDAP v3.
18735 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18736 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738ssl_c_serial : binary
18739 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18740 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18741 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18744 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18745 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18746 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018747 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18748 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18749
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018750 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018751 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18754 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18755 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18756 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018758ssl_c_used : boolean
18759 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18760 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762ssl_c_verify : integer
18763 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18764 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18765 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18766 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768ssl_c_version : integer
18769 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18770 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018771
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018772ssl_f_der : binary
18773 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18774 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18775 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18776
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018777ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018778 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18779 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18780 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18781 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018782 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18784 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18785 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018786 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18787 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18788 LDAP v3.
18789 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18790 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018792ssl_f_key_alg : string
18793 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18794 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18795 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797ssl_f_notafter : string
18798 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18799 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18800 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802ssl_f_notbefore : string
18803 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18804 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18805 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018806
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018807ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18809 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18810 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18811 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18812 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18813 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18814 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18815 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018816 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18817 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18818 LDAP v3.
18819 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18820 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822ssl_f_serial : binary
18823 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18824 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18825 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018826
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018827ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18828 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18829 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18830 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18833 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18834 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18835 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837ssl_f_version : integer
18838 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18839 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18840
18841ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018842 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18843 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18844 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018846 Example :
18847 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18848 listen http-https
18849 bind :80
18850 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18851 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18852
18853ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18854 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18855 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18856
18857ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018858 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018860 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018861 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18862 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18863 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18864 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18865 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18866 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018868ssl_fc_cipher : string
18869 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18870 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018871
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018872ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18873 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18874 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018875 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018876
18877ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18878 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18879 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018880 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018881
18882ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18883 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18884 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18885 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018886 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018887 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018888
18889ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18890 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18891 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018892 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018893
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018894ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18895 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18896 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18897 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18898
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018899ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18900 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18901 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18902 transport layer.
18903 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18904 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18905 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18906 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18907
18908ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18909 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18910 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18911 transport layer.
18912 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18913 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18914 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18915 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18916
18917ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18918 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18919 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18920 transport layer.
18921 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18922 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18923 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18924 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18925
18926ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18927 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18928 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18929 transport layer.
18930 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18931 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18932 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18933 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18934
18935ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18936 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18937 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18938 transport layer.
18939 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18940 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18941 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18942 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018944ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018945 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18946 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018947 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18948 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18949 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18950 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018951
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018952ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18953 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18954 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18955 wait until the handshake happened.
18956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18958 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018959 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18960 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018961 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018962 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018963
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020018964ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
18965 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18966 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
18967 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
18968 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
18969 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
18970 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
18971 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
18972 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
18973 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
18974 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18975
18976ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
18977 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18978 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
18979 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
18980 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
18981 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
18982
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018983ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018984 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018985 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18986 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018989 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018990 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018991 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18992 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18993 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18994 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18995 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18996 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018998ssl_fc_protocol : string
18999 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19000 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019001
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019002ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019004 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19005 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019006
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019007ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19008 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19009 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19010 transport layer.
19011 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19012 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19013 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19014 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19015
19016ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19017 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19018 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19019 transport layer.
19020 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19021 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19022 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19023 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19024
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019025ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19026 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19027 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19028 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19031 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19032 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19033 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19034 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019035
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019036ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19037 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19038 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19039 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19040 BoringSSL.
19041
19042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019043ssl_fc_sni : string
19044 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19045 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019046 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19048 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19049
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019050 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019051 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019053 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019054 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019057 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19058 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19061 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19062 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019063
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019064ssl_s_der : binary
19065 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19066 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19067 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19068
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019069ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19070 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19071 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19072 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019073 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019074 does not support resumed sessions.
19075
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019076ssl_s_key_alg : string
19077 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19078 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19079 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19080
19081ssl_s_notafter : string
19082 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19083 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19084 transport layer.
19085
19086ssl_s_notbefore : string
19087 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19088 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19089 transport layer.
19090
19091ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19092 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19093 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19094 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19095 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19096 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19097 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019098 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19099 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019100 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19101 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19102 LDAP v3.
19103 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19104 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19105
19106ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19107 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19108 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19109 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19110 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19111 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19112 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019113 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19114 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019115 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19116 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19117 LDAP v3.
19118 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19119 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19120
19121ssl_s_serial : binary
19122 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19123 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19124 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19125
19126ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19127 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19128 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19129 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19130
19131ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19132 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19133 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19134 layer.
19135
19136ssl_s_version : integer
19137 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19138 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019139
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19144sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19145only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19146For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19147be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19148can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19149sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19150for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19151content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019152
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019153Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19154 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019155 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019156 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19157 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19158 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19159 sample expression). So be careful.
19160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019161payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019162 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19164 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19167 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019168 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019169 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019171req.len : integer
19172req_len : integer (deprecated)
19173 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19174 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19175 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19176 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19177 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019178 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19180 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19183 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019184 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19185 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19186 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19187 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189 ACL alternatives :
19190 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19193 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19194 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19195 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19196 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198 ACL alternatives :
19199 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019201 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203req.proto_http : boolean
19204req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19205 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19206 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19207 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19208 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19209 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19210 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19211 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 Example:
19214 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19215 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19216 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019217 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019219req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19220rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19221 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19222 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19223 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19224 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19225 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19226 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19227 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019229 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19230 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19231 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19232 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19233 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19234 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019236 ACL derivatives :
19237 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019239 Example :
19240 listen tse-farm
19241 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19242 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19244 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19245 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19246 persist rdp-cookie
19247 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19248 # This is only useful makes sense if
19249 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19250 stick-table type string size 204800
19251 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19252 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19253 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019255 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19256 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019258req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19259rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19260 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19261 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19262 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19263 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265 ACL derivatives :
19266 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019267
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019268req.ssl_alpn : string
19269 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19270 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19271 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19272 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19273 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19274 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019275 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019276
19277 Examples :
19278 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19279 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19280 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019281 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019282 default_backend bk_default
19283
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019284req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19285 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19286 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019287 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19288 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19289 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19290 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19291 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19294req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19295 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19296 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19297 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19298 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19299 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19300 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19301 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019303req.ssl_sni : string
19304req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19305 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19306 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19307 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19308 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19309 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019310 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19311 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19312 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19313 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19314 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19315 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19316 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19317 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19318 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019321 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019323 Examples :
19324 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19325 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19326 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019327 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019329
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019330req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19331 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19332 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19333 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19334 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19335 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19336 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19337 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19338 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19339 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341req.ssl_ver : integer
19342req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19343 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19344 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19345 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19346 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19347 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19348 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19349 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019350 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353 ACL derivatives :
19354 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019355
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019356res.len : integer
19357 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19358 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19359 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19360 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19361 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019362 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019363 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019364 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019366res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19367 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019368 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019369 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019370 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019371 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019373res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19374 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19375 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19376 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019377 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19378 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019381
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019382res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19383rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19384 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19385 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19386 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19387 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19388 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19389 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19390 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392wait_end : boolean
19393 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19394 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019395 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19397 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019398 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19400 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402 Examples :
19403 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19404 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19405 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19408 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19409 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19410 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19411 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19412 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19413 tcp-request content reject
19414
19415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200194167.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417--------------------------------------
19418
19419It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19420This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19421data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19422its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19423HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19424content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19425to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19426more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19427response are indexed.
19428
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019429Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19430 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19431 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19432 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19433 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19434 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19435 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437base : string
19438 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19439 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19440 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19441 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19442 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19443 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19444 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19445 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19446
19447 ACL derivatives :
19448 base : exact string match
19449 base_beg : prefix match
19450 base_dir : subdir match
19451 base_dom : domain match
19452 base_end : suffix match
19453 base_len : length match
19454 base_reg : regex match
19455 base_sub : substring match
19456
19457base32 : integer
19458 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19459 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19460 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019461 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19462 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19463 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464
19465base32+src : binary
19466 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19467 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19468 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19469 per-URL counters.
19470
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019471baseq : string
19472 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19473 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19474 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19475 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19476
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019477capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19478 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19479 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19480 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19481
19482capture.req.method : string
19483 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19484 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19485 because it's allocated.
19486
19487capture.req.uri : string
19488 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19489 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19490 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19491 allocated.
19492
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019493capture.req.ver : string
19494 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19495 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19496 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19497
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019498capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19499 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19500 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19501 The first entry is an index of 0.
19502 See also: "capture response header"
19503
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019504capture.res.ver : string
19505 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19506 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19507 persistent flag.
19508
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019509req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019510 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19511 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19512 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019513
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019514req.body_param([<name>) : string
19515 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19516 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19517 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19518 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19519 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19520 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19521 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19522 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19523 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19524 given.
19525
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019526req.body_len : integer
19527 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19528 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019529 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19530 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019531
19532req.body_size : integer
19533 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019534 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19535 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019537req.cook([<name>]) : string
19538cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19539 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19540 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19541 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19542 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19543 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19544 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19545 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19546 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19547
19548 ACL derivatives :
19549 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19550 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19551 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19552 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19553 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19554 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19555 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19556 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019558req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19559cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19560 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19561 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19564cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19565 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19566 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19567 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19568 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19571 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19572 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19573 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19574 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019575 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19577 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19578 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19579 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19582 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19583 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19584 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19585 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019586 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019588req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019589 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19590 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19591 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19592 with headers such as User-Agent.
19593
19594 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19595 found.
19596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19598 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19599 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019600 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019602req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19603 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19604 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019605 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19606 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019609 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19610 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19611 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19612 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19613 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19614 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19615 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19616
19617 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19618 found.
19619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019620 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19621 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19622 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019623 with -1 being the last one.
19624
19625 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19626 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019628 ACL derivatives :
19629 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19630 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19631 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19632 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19633 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19634 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19635 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19636 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19637
19638req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19639hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19640 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19641 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019642 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19643 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19644 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19645
19646 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19647 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19648 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19649
19650 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019651
19652req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19653hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19654 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19655 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19656 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019657 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19658 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19659 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19660 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19661 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019662
19663 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19664
19665 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019666
19667req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19668hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19669 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19670 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19671 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019672
19673 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19674
19675 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019676
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019677req.hdrs : string
19678 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19679 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19680 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19681 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19682
19683req.hdrs_bin : binary
19684 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19685 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19686 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19687 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19688 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19689 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19690
19691 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019692
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019693 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19694 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19697 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19698 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19699 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19700 basic auth is supported.
19701
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019702http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19703 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19704 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19705 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19706 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019707 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19708 basic auth is supported.
19709
19710 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019711 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19712 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19713 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19714 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019715
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019716http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019717 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19718 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19719 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019720
19721http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019722 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19723 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19724 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019725
19726http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019727 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19728 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19729 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019731http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019732 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19733 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19735 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019737method : integer + string
19738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19739 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19740 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19741 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19742 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19743 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19744 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019746 ACL derivatives :
19747 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019749 Example :
19750 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19751 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19752 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019754path : string
19755 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19756 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19757 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19758 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19759 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019760 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763 ACL derivatives :
19764 path : exact string match
19765 path_beg : prefix match
19766 path_dir : subdir match
19767 path_dom : domain match
19768 path_end : suffix match
19769 path_len : length match
19770 path_reg : regex match
19771 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019772
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019773pathq : string
19774 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19775 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19776 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19777 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19778 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19779 result in both cases.
19780
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019781query : string
19782 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19783 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19784 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19785 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019786 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019787 which stops before the question mark.
19788
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019789req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19790 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19791 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19792 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19793 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019795req.ver : string
19796req_ver : string (deprecated)
19797 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19798 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19799 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019801 ACL derivatives :
19802 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019803
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019804res.body : binary
19805 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19806 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019807 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19808
19809 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019810
19811res.body_len : integer
19812 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19813 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019814 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19815
19816 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019817
19818res.body_size : integer
19819 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19820 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19821 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19822 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019823 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19824
19825 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019826
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019827res.cache_hit : boolean
19828 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19829 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19830
19831res.cache_name : string
19832 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19833 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19834 empty string.
19835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019836res.comp : boolean
19837 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19838 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19839 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019841res.comp_algo : string
19842 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19843 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19844 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846res.cook([<name>]) : string
19847scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19848 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19849 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019850 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19851
19852 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854 ACL derivatives :
19855 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019857res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19858scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19859 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19860 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019861 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19862
19863 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019865res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19866scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19867 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19868 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019869 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19870
19871 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019873res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019874 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19875 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19876
19877 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19878 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19879
19880 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19881
19882 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019884res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019885 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19886 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19887
19888 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19889 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19890
19891 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19894shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019895 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19896 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19897
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019898 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019899 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19900
19901 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019903 ACL derivatives :
19904 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19905 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19906 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19907 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19908 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19909 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19910 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19911 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19912
19913res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19914shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019915 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19916 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19917
19918 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019919 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019920
19921 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019923res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19924shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019925 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19926 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19927
19928 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19929
19930 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019931
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019932res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19933 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19934 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19935 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019936 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19937
19938 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019940res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19941shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019942 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19943 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19944
19945 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19946
19947 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019948
19949res.hdrs : string
19950 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19951 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19952 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019953 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19954
19955 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019956
19957res.hdrs_bin : binary
19958 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19959 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19960 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19961 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19962 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19963 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19964 (length of 0 for both).
19965
19966 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19967
19968 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19969 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019971res.ver : string
19972resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19973 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019974 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19975
19976 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019978 ACL derivatives :
19979 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019981set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19982 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19983 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019984 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019987 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19988 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019990status : integer
19991 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19992 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019993 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19994
19995 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019996
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019997unique-id : string
19998 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19999 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20000 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20001 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20002 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20003 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005url : string
20006 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20007 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20008 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20009 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20010 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20011 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20012 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020014 ACL derivatives :
20015 url : exact string match
20016 url_beg : prefix match
20017 url_dir : subdir match
20018 url_dom : domain match
20019 url_end : suffix match
20020 url_len : length match
20021 url_reg : regex match
20022 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024url_ip : ip
20025 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20026 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20027 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20028 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020029 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20030 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032url_port : integer
20033 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020034 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020035
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020036urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20037url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020038 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20039 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020040 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20041 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20042 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20043 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020044 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20045 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020046 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20047 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020049 ACL derivatives :
20050 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20051 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20052 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20053 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20054 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20055 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20056 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20057 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020058
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020060 Example :
20061 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20062 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20063 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20064 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020065
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020066urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020067 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20068 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20069 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020070
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020071url32 : integer
20072 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20073 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20074 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20075 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20076 is an unsigned integer.
20077
20078url32+src : binary
20079 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20080 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20081 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20082
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020083
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200847.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020085---------------------------------------
20086
20087This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20088used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20089purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20090There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20091or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20092any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20093for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20094
20095internal.htx.data : integer
20096 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20097 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20098
20099internal.htx.free : integer
20100 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20101 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20102
20103internal.htx.free_data : integer
20104 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20105 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20106
20107internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020108 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20109 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20110 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020111
20112internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20113 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20114 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20115
20116internal.htx.size : integer
20117 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20118 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20119
20120internal.htx.used : integer
20121 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20122 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20123 direction.
20124
20125internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20126 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20127 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20128 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20129 of the special value :
20130 * head : The oldest inserted block
20131 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020132 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020133
20134internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20135 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20136 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20137 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20138 integer or one of the special value :
20139 * head : The oldest inserted block
20140 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020141 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020142
20143internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20144 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20145 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20146 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20147 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20148
20149 * head : The oldest inserted block
20150 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020151 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020152
20153internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20154 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20155 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20156 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20157 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20158
20159 * head : The oldest inserted block
20160 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020161 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020162
20163internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20164 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20165 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20166 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20167 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20168
20169 * head : The oldest inserted block
20170 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020171 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020172
20173internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20174 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20175 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20176 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20177 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20178
20179 * head : The oldest inserted block
20180 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020181 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020182
20183internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20184 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20185 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20186 it returns false.
20187
20188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020190---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020192Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20193every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020194order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020196ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020197---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20198FALSE always_false never match
20199HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20200HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20201HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020202HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020203HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20204HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20205HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20206HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20207LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20208METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20209METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20210METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20211METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20212METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20213METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20214METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20215METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20216RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20217REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20218TRUE always_true always match
20219WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20220---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020221
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202238. Logging
20224----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020225
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020226One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20227provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20228very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20229provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20230state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020231to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020232headers.
20233
20234In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20235about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20236send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20237
20238 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20239 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20240 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20241 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20242 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020243 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020244 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245
20246The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20247allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20248as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20249while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20250real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20251delay.
20252
20253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202548.1. Log levels
20255---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020256
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020257TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020258source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020259HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20260in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20261track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20262syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20263about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264
20265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202668.2. Log formats
20267----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020268
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020269HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020270and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20271slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20272options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020273
20274 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20275 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20276 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20277 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20278 extents.
20279
20280 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20281 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20282 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20283 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20284 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20285
20286 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20287 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20288 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20289 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20290 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20291
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020292 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20293 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20294 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20295 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20296
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020297 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020299Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20300specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20301field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20302servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20303always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20304identifier.
20305
20306Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20307 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20308 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20309 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20310 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20311
20312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203138.2.1. Default log format
20314-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020315
20316This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20317as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20318format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20319
20320 Example :
20321 listen www
20322 mode http
20323 log global
20324 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20325
20326 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20327 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20328 (www/HTTP)
20329
20330 Field Format Extract from the example above
20331 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20332 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20333 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20334 4 'to' to
20335 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20336 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20337
20338Detailed fields description :
20339 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20340 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20341 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20342 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20343 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20344 and processed the connection.
20345 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20346
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020347In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20348"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20349connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20350
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020351It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20352will eventually disappear.
20353
20354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203558.2.2. TCP log format
20356---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020357
20358The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20359is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20360information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20361counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20362emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20363environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20364the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20365sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020366specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20367not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20368fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20369marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020370
20371 Example :
20372 frontend fnt
20373 mode tcp
20374 option tcplog
20375 log global
20376 default_backend bck
20377
20378 backend bck
20379 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20380
20381 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20382 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20383 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20384
20385 Field Format Extract from the example above
20386 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20387 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20388 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20389 4 frontend_name fnt
20390 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20391 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20392 7 bytes_read* 212
20393 8 termination_state --
20394 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20395 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20396
20397Detailed fields description :
20398 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020399 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020400 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20401 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020402 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020403 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020404 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020405
20406 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020407 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20408 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20409 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020410
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020411 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020412 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20413 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020414 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20415 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20416 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20417 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020418
20419 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20420 and processed the connection.
20421
20422 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20423 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20424 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20425 applications.
20426
20427 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20428 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20429 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20430 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20431 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20432
20433 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20434 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20435 See "Timers" below for more details.
20436
20437 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20438 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20439 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20440 "Timers" below for more details.
20441
20442 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020443 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020444 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20445 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20446 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20447 details.
20448
20449 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20450 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20451 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20452 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20453 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20454
20455 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20456 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20457 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20458 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20459 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20460 for more details.
20461
20462 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020463 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020464 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20465 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20466 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020467 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020468
20469 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20470 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20471 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20472 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20473 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20474 caused by a denial of service attack.
20475
20476 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20477 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20478 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20479 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20480 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20481 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20482 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20483 denial of service attack.
20484
20485 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20486 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20487 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20488 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20489 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20490 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20491 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20492 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20493 be processed than on other servers.
20494
20495 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20496 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20497 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20498 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020499 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20501 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20502 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20503 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20504 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20505 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20506 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20507 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20508
20509 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20510 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20511 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20512 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20513 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20514 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020515 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020516 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20517
20518 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20519 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20520 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20521 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20522 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20523 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020524 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020525 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20526 occurs.
20527
20528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205298.2.3. HTTP log format
20530----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020531
20532The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20533is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20534the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20535are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20536emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20537generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20538"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20539which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020540frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20541is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020542
20543Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20544slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20545with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20546
20547 Example :
20548 frontend http-in
20549 mode http
20550 option httplog
20551 log global
20552 default_backend bck
20553
20554 backend static
20555 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20556
20557 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20558 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20559 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020560 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020561
20562 Field Format Extract from the example above
20563 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20564 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020565 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020566 4 frontend_name http-in
20567 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020568 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569 7 status_code 200
20570 8 bytes_read* 2750
20571 9 captured_request_cookie -
20572 10 captured_response_cookie -
20573 11 termination_state ----
20574 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20575 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20576 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20577 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20578 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020579
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580Detailed fields description :
20581 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020582 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020583 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20584 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020585 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020586 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020587 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020588
20589 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020590 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20591 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20592 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020593
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020594 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020595 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020596
20597 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20598 and processed the connection.
20599
20600 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20601 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20602 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20603
20604 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20605 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20606 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20607 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20608 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20609 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20610
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020611 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20612 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20613 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020614 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020615 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20616 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020617 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020618 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020619
20620 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20621 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020622 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020623
20624 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20625 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020626 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20627 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020628
20629 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20630 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20631 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20632 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20633 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020634 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20635 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020636
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020637 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020638 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20639 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20640 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20641 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20642 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20643 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020644 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020645
20646 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020647 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20648 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020649
20650 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20651 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020652 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020653 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20654 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20655 overflowing.
20656
20657 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20658 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20659 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20660 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20661 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20662 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20663 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20664 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20665
20666 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20667 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20668 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20669 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20670 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20671 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20672 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20673 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20674
20675 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20676 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20677 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20678 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20679 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20680 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20681 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20682
20683 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020684 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020685 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20686 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20687 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020688 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020689 system.
20690
20691 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20692 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20693 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20694 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20695 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20696 caused by a denial of service attack.
20697
20698 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20699 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20700 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20701 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20702 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20703 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20704 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20705 denial of service attack.
20706
20707 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20708 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20709 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20710 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20711 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20712 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20713 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20714 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20715 processed than on other servers.
20716
20717 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20718 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20719 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20720 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020721 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020722 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20723 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20724 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20725 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20726 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20727 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20728 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20729 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20730
20731 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20732 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20733 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20734 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20735 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20736 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020737 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020738 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20739
20740 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20741 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20742 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20743 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20744 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20745 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020746 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020747 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20748 occurs.
20749
20750 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20751 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20752 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20753 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20754 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20755 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20756 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20757 cookies" below for more details.
20758
20759 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20760 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20761 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20762 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20763 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20764 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20765 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20766 and cookies" below for more details.
20767
20768 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20769 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20770 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20771 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20772 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20773 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20774 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20775 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20776
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020777
207788.2.4. HTTPS log format
20779----------------------
20780
20781The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20782extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20783information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20784frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20785end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20786matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20787sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20788dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20789"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20790
20791This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20792appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20793HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020794
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020795 Example :
20796 frontend https-in
20797 mode http
20798 option httpslog
20799 log global
20800 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
20801 default_backend bck
20802
20803 backend static
20804 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
20805
20806 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20807 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
20808 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
20809 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20810
20811 Field Format Extract from the example above
20812 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20813 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
20814 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
20815 4 frontend_name https-in
20816 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
20817 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
20818 7 status_code 200
20819 8 bytes_read* 2750
20820 9 captured_request_cookie -
20821 10 captured_response_cookie -
20822 11 termination_state ----
20823 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20824 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20825 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20826 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20827 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
20828 17 conn_status '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
20829 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20830
20831Detailed fields description :
20832 - "conn_status" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
20833 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
20834 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
20835
20836 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
20837 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
20838 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
20839
20840 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
20841 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
20842 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
20843 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
20844
20845 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
20846 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
20847 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
20848 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
20849
20850 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
20851
20852 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
20853
20854
208558.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020856------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020857
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020858The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020859mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020860
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020861HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020862Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20863separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20864prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20865
20866Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20867variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020868("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020869
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020870If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020871as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020872less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20873the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20874
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020875Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20876"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20877delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20878preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020879
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020880Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20881'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20882https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20883such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20884
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020885Flags are :
20886 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020887 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020888 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20889 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020890
20891 Example:
20892
20893 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20894 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20895
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020896 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20897
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020898At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020900 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20901 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020902
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020903the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020904
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020905 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20906 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20907 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020908
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020909the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
20910
20911 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20912 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
20913 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
20914 %sslv/%sslc"
20915
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020916and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20917
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020918 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20919 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020920
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020921Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20922
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020923 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020924 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020925 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20926 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20927 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020928 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20929 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20930 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020931 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020932 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020933 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020934 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020935 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020936 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20937 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020938 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020939 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020940 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020941 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020942 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020943 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020944 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020945 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20946 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20947 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20948 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20949 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020950 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020951 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020952 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020953 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020954 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020955 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20956 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020957 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20958 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20959 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020960 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020961 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20962 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020963 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020964 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20965 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20966 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020967 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020968 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020969 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20970 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20971 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20972 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020973 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020974 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020975 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020976 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020977 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020978 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020979 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20980 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20981 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020982 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020983 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20984 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020985 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020986 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20987 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020988 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020989 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020990 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020991 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020992
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020993 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020994
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020995
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200209968.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020997-----------------------
20998
20999When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021000protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021001By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21002"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021003will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +020021004logged if the "dontlognull" option is set. If the "log-error-via-logformat" option
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +020021005is set, those messages are not emitted and a line following the configured
21006log-format is emitted instead.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021007
21008The format looks like this :
21009
21010 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21011 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21012 Connection error during SSL handshake
21013
21014 Field Format Extract from the example above
21015 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21016 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21017 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21018 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21019 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21020
21021These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21022failures.
21023
21024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210258.3. Advanced logging options
21026-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027
21028Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21029just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21030options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21031for more information about their usage.
21032
21033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210348.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21035------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036
21037It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021038HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021039commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21040monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21041ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21042
21043 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21044 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21045 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21046 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21047
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021048 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21049 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021050
21051 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21052 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21053 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21054
21055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210568.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21057----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021058
21059The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21060what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21061or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021062"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21064log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21065after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21066is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21067with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21068with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21069
21070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210718.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21072------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021073
21074Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21075for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21076"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21077retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21078raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21079a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21080file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21081you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21082"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21083
21084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210858.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21086--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021087
21088Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21089multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21090them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21091"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21092logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21093error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21094and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21095too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21096useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21097alternative.
21098
21099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211008.4. Timing events
21101------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021102
21103Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21104reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21105the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21106frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021107mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21108addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21109
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021110Timings events in HTTP mode:
21111
21112 first request 2nd request
21113 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21114 t tr t tr ...
21115 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21116 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21117 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21118 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021119 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021120 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21121
21122Timings events in TCP mode:
21123
21124 TCP session
21125 |<----------------->|
21126 t t
21127 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21128 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21129 |<------ Tt ------->|
21130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021131 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021132 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021133 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21134 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21135 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021136 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021137 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21138 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21139 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21140 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021141
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021142 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21143 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21144 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021145 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21146 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21147 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21148 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21149 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21150 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021151
21152 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21153 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21154 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21155 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21156 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21157 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21158 request typed by hand during a test.
21159
21160 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21161 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021162 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021163 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21164 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21165 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21166 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167
21168 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21169 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21170 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21171 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21172 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21173
21174 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21175 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21176 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21177 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21178 connection never established.
21179
21180 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21181 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21182 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21183 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21184 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21185 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21186 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21187 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21188 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21189 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21190 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21191
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021192 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21193 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21194 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21195 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21196 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21197 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21198
21199 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21200
21201 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21202 "Ta" can never be negative.
21203
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021204 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21205 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021206 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21207 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021208 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021209
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021210 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211
21212 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021213 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21214 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021215
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021216 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21217 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21218 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21219 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21220 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21221 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21222 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21223 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21224
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021225These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21226protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21227that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021228due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21229"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21230that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231
21232Most common cases :
21233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021234 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21235 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21236 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21237 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21238 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021239 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021240 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21241 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21242 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21243 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21244 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021245 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246
21247 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21248 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21249 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21250 of ms on remote networks.
21251
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021252 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21253 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21254 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021256 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21257 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021258 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021259 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21260 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21261 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21262 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21263 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21264 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021265
21266Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21267
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021268 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021269 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021270 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021272 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021273 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21274 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21275
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021276 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021277 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21278 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21279 flags.
21280
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021281 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21282 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021283 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21284 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21285 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21286 the client connection was maintained open.
21287
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021288 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021289 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021290 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021291 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21292
21293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212948.5. Session state at disconnection
21295-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021296
21297TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21298"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
212992-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21300each of which has a special meaning :
21301
21302 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21303 session to terminate :
21304
21305 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21306
21307 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21308 server explicitly refused it.
21309
21310 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21311 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21312 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21313 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021314 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021315
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021316 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021317 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021318
21319 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21320 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21321 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21322 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21323 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21324
21325 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21326 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21327 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21328 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21329 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21330
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021331 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021332 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21333
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021334 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021335 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21336 backup connections when going up.
21337
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021338 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021340 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21341 send or receive data.
21342
21343 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21344 send or receive data.
21345
21346 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21347 with nothing left in the buffers.
21348
21349 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21350
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021351 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021352 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21353
21354 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21355 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21356 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21357 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21358 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21359
21360 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21361 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21362
21363 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21364 server (HTTP only).
21365
21366 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21367
21368 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21369 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21370 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21371
21372 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21373 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21374 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21375
21376 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21377
21378 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21379 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21380
21381 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21382 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21383 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21384
21385 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21386 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021387 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21388 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021389
21390 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21391 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21392 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21393 another server.
21394
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021395 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396 server.
21397
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021398 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21399 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21400 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21401 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21402
21403 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21404 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21405 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21406 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21407
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021408 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21409 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21410 "use-server" rule).
21411
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021412 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21413
21414 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21415 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21416
21417 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21418
21419 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21420 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21421 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21422
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021423 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21424 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021425 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021426 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21427 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21428
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021429 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21430
21431 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21432 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21433
21434 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21435
21436 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21437
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021438The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21439was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021440helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21441starvation, attacks, etc...
21442
21443The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21444alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21445easier finding and understanding.
21446
21447 Flags Reason
21448
21449 -- Normal termination.
21450
21451 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021452 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21453 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021454 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21455
21456 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21457 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021458 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21459 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021460 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21461 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021462
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021463 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21464 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021465 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021466
21467 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21468 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21469 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21470
21471 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21472 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21473 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21474 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21475 the server takes too long to respond.
21476
21477 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21478 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21479 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21480 long a time to respond.
21481
21482 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21483 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21484 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021485 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021486 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21487 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021488
21489 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21490 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21491 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21492 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21493 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021494 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021495 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21496 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21497 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21498 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21499 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21500 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21501 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21502 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021503 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021504 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21505 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21506 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021507
21508 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21509 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021510 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21511 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21512 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21513 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021514
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021515 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021516 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21517
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021518 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021519 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21520 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021521 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021522 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21523 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21524
21525 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21526 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21527 503 or 504 here.
21528
21529 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021530 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021531 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21532 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21533 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21534
21535 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21536 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021537 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021538 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021539 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021540
21541 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21542 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21543 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21544 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21545 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21546 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021547 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021548
21549 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21550 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21551 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21552 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21553 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21554 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21555 solution is to fix the application.
21556
21557 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21558 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21559 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21560 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21561 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21562 external attacks.
21563
21564 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021565 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021566 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021567 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21568 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21569
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021570 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21571 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21572 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021573 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021574 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021575
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021576 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21577 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21578 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21579 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021580 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21581 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21582 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21583 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21584 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021585
21586 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21587 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21588 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21589 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21590
21591 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21592 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21593 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21594 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21595
21596 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21597 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21598 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21599 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21600
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021601The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021602persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021603important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21604re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21605
21606 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21607
21608 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21609 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21610 set on a GET request.
21611
21612 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21613 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021614 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021615 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21616
21617 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21618 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21619 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21620
21621 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21622 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21623 already got a cookie.
21624
21625 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21626 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21627 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21628 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21629 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21630
21631 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21632 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21633 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21634
21635 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21636 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21637 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21638
21639 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21640 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21641
21642 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21643 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21644 then advertised in the response.
21645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216478.6. Non-printable characters
21648-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021649
21650In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21651consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21652converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21653prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21654being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21655escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21656is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21657'}' when logging headers.
21658
21659Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21660issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21661containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21662
21663Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21664the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21665performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21666
21667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216688.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21669---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021670
21671Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21672achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021673section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021674cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21675the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21676the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021677locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021678not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21679user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21680a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21681wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21682
21683 Examples :
21684 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21685 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21686
21687 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21688 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21689
21690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21692---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021693
21694Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21695proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21696the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21697server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21698
21699Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21700response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021701section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021702
21703It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021704time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21705appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021706are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21707and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21708follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21709request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21710in the logs.
21711
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021712As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21713frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21714an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21715
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021716 Example :
21717 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21718 listen proxy-out
21719 mode http
21720 option httplog
21721 option logasap
21722 log global
21723 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21724
21725 # log the name of the virtual server
21726 capture request header Host len 20
21727
21728 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21729 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21730
21731 # log the beginning of the referrer
21732 capture request header Referer len 20
21733
21734 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21735 capture response header Server len 20
21736
21737 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21738 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021740 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021741 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21742
21743 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21744 capture response header Via len 20
21745
21746 # log the URL location during a redirection
21747 capture response header Location len 20
21748
21749 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21750 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21751 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21752 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21753 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21754
21755 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21756 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21757 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21758 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021759 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021760
21761 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21762 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21763 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21764 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21765 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021766 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021767
21768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217698.9. Examples of logs
21770---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021771
21772These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21773them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21774reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21775
21776 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21777 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21778 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21779
21780 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21781 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21782
21783 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21784 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21785 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21786
21787 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21788 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21789
21790 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21791 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21792 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21793
21794 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021795 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021796 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21797 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21798
21799 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21800 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21801 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21802
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021803 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21804 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21805 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21806 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021807 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021808 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021809
21810 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021811 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021812
21813 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21814 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21815 Nothing was sent to any server.
21816
21817 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21818 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21819
21820 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21821 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021822 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021823 send a 408 return code to the client.
21824
21825 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21826 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21827
21828 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21829 5 seconds ("c----").
21830
21831 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21832 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021833 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021834
21835 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021836 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021837 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21838 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21839 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21840 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21841 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021842
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021843
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200218449. Supported filters
21845--------------------
21846
21847Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21848accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21849unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21850
21851See also : "filter"
21852
218539.1. Trace
21854----------
21855
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021856filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021857
21858 Arguments:
21859 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21860 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21861
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021862 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021864 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021865 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21866 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21867 amount of the parsed data.
21868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021869 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021870
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021871This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21872callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21873information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21874filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21875
21876Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21877tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21878a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21879
21880
218819.2. HTTP compression
21882---------------------
21883
21884filter compression
21885
21886The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21887keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021888when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21889fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21890done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21891explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21892filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21893listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21894order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021895
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021896See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21897 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021898
21899
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200219009.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21901--------------------------------------------
21902
21903filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21904
21905 Arguments :
21906
21907 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21908 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21909 parsed.
21910
21911 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21912 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21913 part must be placed in its own scope.
21914
21915The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21916external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021917streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021918exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21919also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21920
21921SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21922the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21923
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021924For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021925"doc/SPOE.txt".
21926
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100219279.4. Cache
21928----------
21929
21930filter cache <name>
21931
21932 Arguments :
21933
21934 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21935
21936The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21937"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021938cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021939other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21940case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21941is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21942filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021943listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21944order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021945
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021946See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21947 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21948
21949
219509.5. Fcgi-app
21951-------------
21952
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021953filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021954
21955 Arguments :
21956
21957 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21958
21959The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21960request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21961reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21962used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21963implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21964used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21965fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21966used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21967order.
21968
21969See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21970 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21971
21972
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100219739.6. OpenTracing
21974----------------
21975
21976The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21977HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21978of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21979Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21980
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021981This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021982
21983The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21984HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21985participates in the work of HAProxy.
21986
21987filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21988
21989 Arguments :
21990
21991 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21992 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21993 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21994 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21995 OpenTracing filters.
21996
21997 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21998 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21999 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22000 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22001 filter must have its own scope defined.
22002
22003More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022004of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022005
22006
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002200710. FastCGI applications
22008-------------------------
22009
22010HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22011feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22012the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22013FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22014servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22015FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22016backend.
22017
22018HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22019application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22020connection.
22021
2202210.1. Setup
22023-----------
22024
2202510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22026--------------------------
22027
22028fcgi-app <name>
22029 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22030 document root must be defined.
22031
22032acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22033 Declare or complete an access list.
22034
22035 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22036 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22037 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22038 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22039 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22040
22041docroot <path>
22042 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22043 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22044 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22045
22046index <script-name>
22047 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22048 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22049 is an optional setting.
22050
22051 Example :
22052 index index.php
22053
22054log-stderr global
22055log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022056 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022057 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22058
22059 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22060 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22061
22062pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22063 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22064 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22065 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22066
22067 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22068 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22069 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22070 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22071
22072 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22073 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22074
22075path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022076 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022077 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22078 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22079 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22080 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22081 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22082 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22083 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022084
22085 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022086 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022087 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22088 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22089 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22090 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022091
22092 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022093 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22094 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022095
22096option get-values
22097no option get-values
22098 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22099
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022100 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022101 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22102
22103 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22104 application will accept.
22105
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022106 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22107 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022108
22109 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022110 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022111 option is disabled.
22112
22113 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22114 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22115 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22116 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22117 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22118 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22119
22120option keep-conn
22121no option keep-conn
22122 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22123 sending a response.
22124
22125 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22126 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22127
22128option max-reqs <reqs>
22129 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22130 accept.
22131
22132 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22133 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22134 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22135 to 1.
22136
22137option mpxs-conns
22138no option mpxs-conns
22139 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22140
22141 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22142 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22143
22144set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22145 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22146 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22147 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22148 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22149
22150 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22151 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22152 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22153
22154 Example :
22155 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22156 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22157
22158 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22159
22160
2216110.1.2. Proxy section
22162---------------------
22163
22164use-fcgi-app <name>
22165 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22166
22167 Arguments :
22168 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22169
22170 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22171 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22172 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22173 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22174 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22175
22176 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22177 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22178 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22179 application are evaluated.
22180
22181
2218210.1.3. Example
22183---------------
22184
22185 frontend front-http
22186 mode http
22187 bind *:80
22188 bind *:
22189
22190 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22191 default_backend back-static
22192
22193 backend back-static
22194 mode http
22195 server www A.B.C.D:80
22196
22197 backend back-dynamic
22198 mode http
22199 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22200 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22201
22202 fcgi-app php-fpm
22203 log-stderr global
22204 option keep-conn
22205
22206 docroot /var/www/my-app
22207 index index.php
22208 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22209
22210
2221110.2. Default parameters
22212------------------------
22213
22214A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22215the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022216script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022217applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22218
22219 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22220 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22221 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22222 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22223 | | |
22224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22225 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22226 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22227 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22228 | | application. |
22229 | | |
22230 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22231 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22232 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22233 | | |
22234 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22235 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22236 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22237 | | the application's configuration. |
22238 | | |
22239 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22240 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22241 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22242 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22243 | | |
22244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22245 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22246 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22247 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22248 | | be defined. |
22249 | | |
22250 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22251 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22252 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22253 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22254 | | is not set too. |
22255 | | |
22256 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22257 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22258 | | set. |
22259 | | |
22260 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22261 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22262 | | the request. |
22263 | | |
22264 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22265 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22266 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22267 | | |
22268 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22269 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22270 | | script to process the request. |
22271 | | |
22272 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22273 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22274 | | |
22275 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22276 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22277 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22278 | | |
22279 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22280 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22281 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22282 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22283 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22284 | | |
22285 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22286 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22287 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22288 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22289 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22290 | | side. |
22291 | | |
22292 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22293 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22294 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22295 | | connected to. |
22296 | | |
22297 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22298 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22299 | | |
22300 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022301 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22302 | | current HAProxy version. |
22303 | | |
22304 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022305 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22306 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22307 | | |
22308 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22309
22310
2231110.3. Limitations
22312------------------
22313
22314The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22315way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22316during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22317establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22318application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22319or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22320message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22321these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22322and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22323
22324Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22325request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22326requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22327
22328About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22329into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22330fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22331"http-request" ones.
22332
22333Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22334FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22335processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22336must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22337here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022338
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022339
2234011. Address formats
22341-------------------
22342
22343Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22344address.
22345
22346This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22347The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22348of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22349equivalent is '::'.
22350
22351Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22352is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22353
22354This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22355family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22356
22357Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22358configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22359use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22360'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22361
22362Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22363socket type and the transport method.
22364
22365
2236611.1 Address family prefixes
22367----------------------------
22368
22369'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22370
22371'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22372 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22373 listening.
22374
22375'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22376 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22377 on the statement using this address, a port or
22378 a port range may or must be specified.
22379
22380'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22381 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22382 using this address, a port or a port range
22383 may or must be specified.
22384
22385'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22386 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22387 using this address, a port or a port range
22388 may or must be specified.
22389
22390'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22391 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22392 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22393 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22394 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22395 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22396
22397'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22398 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22399 start by slash '/'.
22400
22401
2240211.2 Socket type prefixes
22403-------------------------
22404
22405Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22406type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22407this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22408This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22409but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22410
22411Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22412instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22413
22414If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22415they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22416report this to the maintainers.
22417
22418'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22419 to "stream"
22420
22421'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22422 to "datagram".
22423
22424
2242511.3 Protocol prefixes
22426----------------------
22427
22428'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22429 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22430 socket type and transport method is forced to
22431 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22432 this address, a port or a port range can or
22433 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22434 of 'stream+ip@'.
22435
22436'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22437 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22438 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22439 statement using this address, a port or port
22440 range can or must be specified.
22441 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22442
22443'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22444 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22445 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22446 statement using this address, a port or port
22447 range can or must be specified.
22448 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22449
22450'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22451 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22452 socket type and transport method is forced to
22453 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22454 this address, a port or a port range can or
22455 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22456 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22457
22458'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22459 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22460 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22461 the statement using this address, a port or
22462 port range can or must be specified.
22463 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22464
22465'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22466 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22467 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22468 the statement using this address, a port or
22469 port range can or must be specified.
22470 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22471
22472'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22473 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22474 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22475
22476'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22477 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22478 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22479
22480In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22481QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022483/*
22484 * Local variables:
22485 * fill-column: 79
22486 * End:
22487 */